c36047f07a2d2234024af78b087ecd4d611332e5
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, kitprog.
2375 The following adapters have their own command to specify the serial string:
2376 hla, jlink, presto, st-link, vsllink, xds110.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @section Interface Drivers
2380
2381 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2382 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2383 available at run time.
2384
2385 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2386 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2387 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2388 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2389
2390 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2391 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2392 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2396 Displays status of RTCK option.
2397 Optionally sets that option first.
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2402 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2403 This has one driver-specific command:
2404
2405 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2406 Logs some status
2407 @end deffn
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2411 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2412 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2413 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2414 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2415 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2419 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2420 or v2 (USB bulk).
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2423 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2424 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2425 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2426 @example
2427 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2428 @end example
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2432 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2433
2434 @itemize @minus
2435 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2436 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2437 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2438 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2439 @end itemize
2440 @end deffn
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2443 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2444 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2445 interface string or for user class interface.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2449 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2450 @end deffn
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2454 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2458 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2462 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2463 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2464
2465 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2466 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2467
2468 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2469 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2470
2471 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2472 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2473 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2474 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2475 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2476 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2477
2478 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2479 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2480 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2481 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2482 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2483
2484 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2485 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2486 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2487 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2488
2489 @itemize @minus
2490 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2491 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2493 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2494 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2495 switching data and direction as necessary
2496 @end itemize
2497
2498 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2499 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2502 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2503 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2504 @example
2505 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2506 @end example
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2510 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2511 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2512 during device selection.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2516 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2517 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2521 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2522 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2523 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2524 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2525 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2526 and initially asserted reset signals.
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2530 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2531 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2532 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2533 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2534 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2535 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2536 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2537 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2538 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2539 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2540
2541 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2542 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2543 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2544 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2545 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2546 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2547
2548 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2549 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2550 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2551 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2552 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2553 are always driven by the FTDI.
2554
2555 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2556 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2557 @var{name}.
2558 @end deffn
2559
2560 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2561 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2562 @itemize @minus
2563 @item @option{0}, drive low
2564 @item @option{1}, drive high
2565 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2566 @end itemize
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2570 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2574 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2575
2576 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2577 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2578 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2579 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2580 @itemize @minus
2581 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2582 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2583 @end itemize
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2587 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2588
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2592 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2593 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2594 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2595
2596 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2597 @itemize @minus
2598 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2599 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2600 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2601 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2602 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2603 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2604 @end itemize
2605
2606 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2607 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2608 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2609 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2610 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2611 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2612 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2613 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2614
2615 FT232R
2616 @itemize @minus
2617 @item bit 7 - RI
2618 @item bit 6 - DCD
2619 @item bit 5 - DSR
2620 @item bit 4 - DTR
2621 @item bit 3 - CTS
2622 @item bit 2 - RTS
2623 @item bit 1 - RXD
2624 @item bit 0 - TXD
2625 @end itemize
2626
2627 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2628 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2631 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2632 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2636 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2637 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2641 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2645 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2649 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2653 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2654 @end deffn
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2657 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2661 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2665 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2666 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2667 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2668 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2669 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2670 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2671 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2672 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2673 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2679 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2680 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2681 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2682
2683 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2684 processors which are being simulated.
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2687 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2688 sockets instead of TCP.
2689 @end deffn
2690
2691 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2692 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2693 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2697 something like:
2698
2699 @example
2700 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2701 remote_bitbang port 3335
2702 remote_bitbang host foobar
2703 @end example
2704
2705 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2706 named mysocket:
2707
2708 @example
2709 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2710 remote_bitbang port 0
2711 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2712 @end example
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2716 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2717 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2718 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2721 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2722 default values are used.
2723 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2724 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2725 @example
2726 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2727 @end example
2728 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2729 @example
2730 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2735 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2736 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2737 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2738 target board.
2739
2740 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2741 @example
2742 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2743 reset_config srst_only
2744 @end example
2745 @end deffn
2746
2747 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2748 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2749 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2750 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2751 @end deffn
2752
2753 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2754 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2755 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2761 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2762 This has one driver-specific command:
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2765 Display either the address of the I/O port
2766 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2767 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2768 This is a write-once setting.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @end deffn
2771
2772 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2773 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2774 transports.
2775
2776 @quotation Compatibility Note
2777 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2778 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2779 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2780 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2781 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2782 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2783 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2784 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2785 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2786 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2787 @end quotation
2788
2789 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2790 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2791 states.
2792 @end deffn
2793 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2794 Display free device internal memory.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2797 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2798 command version.
2799 @end deffn
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2801 Display the device configuration.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2804 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2805 power state.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2808 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2809 @end deffn
2810 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2811 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2812 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2813 IP configuration.
2814 @end deffn
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2816 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2817 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2820 Reset the current configuration.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2823 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2826 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2827 pairs.
2828
2829 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2830 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2831 @example
2832 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2833 @end example
2834 @end deffn
2835 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2836 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2837 pairs.
2838
2839 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2840 @example
2841 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2842 77a90000
2843 @end example
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2846 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2847 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2848 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2849 the serial number instead, if possible.
2850
2851 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2854 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2855 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2856
2857 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2858 @end deffn
2859 @end deffn
2860
2861 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2862 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2863 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2864 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2865 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2866 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2867 configuration script.
2868
2869 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2870 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2871 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2872 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2873 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2874
2875 Known limitations:
2876 @itemize @bullet
2877 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2878 and 2.7 MHz.
2879 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2880 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2881 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2882 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2883 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2884 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2885 communications with the target.
2886 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2887 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2888 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2889 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2890 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2891 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2892 @end itemize
2893
2894 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2895 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2896 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2900 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2901 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2902 target as a side-effect.
2903 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2907 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2908 version, and target voltage.
2909 @end deffn
2910 @end deffn
2911
2912 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2913 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2914 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2915 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2916 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2917
2918 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2919 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2920 This is a write-once setting.
2921 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2922
2923 @itemize @minus
2924 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2925 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2926 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2927 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2928 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2929 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2930 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2931 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2932 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2933 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2934 some versions of
2935 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2936 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2937 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2938 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2939 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2940 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2941 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2942 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2943 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2944 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2945 @end itemize
2946 @end deffn
2947
2948 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2949 Display either the address of the I/O port
2950 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2951 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2952 This is a write-once setting.
2953
2954 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2955 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2956 you may encounter a problem.
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2960 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2961 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2962 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2963 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2964 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2965
2966 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2967 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2968 @quotation Tip
2969 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2970 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2971 @example
2972 > parport toggling_time 1000
2973 > adapter speed 500
2974 @end example
2975 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2976 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2977 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2978 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2979 large set of samples.
2980 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2981 @example
2982 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2983 @end example
2984 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2985 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2986
2987 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2988 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2989 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2990 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2991 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
2992 be conservative.
2993 @end quotation
2994 @end deffn
2995
2996 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2997 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2998 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2999 @end deffn
3000
3001 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3002 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3003
3004 @example
3005 adapter driver parport
3006 parport port 0x278
3007 parport cable wiggler
3008 @end example
3009 @end deffn
3010
3011 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3012 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3013 @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
3014 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3015 @end deffn
3016 @end deffn
3017
3018 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3019 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3020 @end deffn
3021
3022 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3023 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3027 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3028
3029 @quotation Note
3030 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3031 which are not currently documented here.
3032 @end quotation
3033 @end deffn
3034
3035 @anchor{hla_interface}
3036 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3037 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3038 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3039 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3040
3041 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3042 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3043 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3044 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3045 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3046 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3047
3048 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3049 Currently Not Supported.
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3053 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3054 @end deffn
3055
3056 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3057 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3058 @end deffn
3059
3060 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3061 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3065 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3066 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3067
3068 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3069 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3070 ST-LINK server software module}.
3071 @end deffn
3072
3073 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3074 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3075 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3076 @end deffn
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3080 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3081 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3082 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3083 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3084
3085 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3086 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3087 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3088 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3089
3090 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3091 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3092
3093 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3094 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3095 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3096
3097 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3098 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3099 ST-LINK server software module}.
3100
3101 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3102 @end deffn
3103
3104 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3105 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3106 @end deffn
3107
3108 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3109 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3110 @end deffn
3111
3112 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3113 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3114 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3115
3116 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3117 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3118 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3119 the target's supply voltage.
3120 @example
3121 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3122 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3123 @end example
3124 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3125 @example
3126 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3127 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3128 3.24891518738
3129 @end example
3130 @end deffn
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3134 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3135 @end deffn
3136
3137 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3138 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3139 @end deffn
3140
3141 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3142 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3143 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3144 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3145 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3146
3147 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3148 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3149 XDS110 found will be used.
3150 @end deffn
3151
3152 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3153 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3154 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3155 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3156 @end deffn
3157
3158 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3159 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3160 version).
3161 @end deffn
3162 @end deffn
3163
3164 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3165 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3166 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3167 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3168 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3169
3170 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3171
3172 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3173 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3174
3175 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3176 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3177
3178 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3179
3180 @end deffn
3181 @end deffn
3182
3183 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3184 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3185 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3186
3187 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3188 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3189 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3190 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3191 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3192 configuration on exit.
3193
3194 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3195
3196 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3197 pinout.
3198
3199 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3200 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3201 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3202 individually.
3203 @end deffn
3204
3205 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3206 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3207 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3208 @end deffn
3209
3210 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3211 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3212 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3216 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3217 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3218 @end deffn
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3221 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3222 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3226 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3227 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3228 @end deffn
3229
3230 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3231 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3232 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3233 @end deffn
3234
3235 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3236 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3237 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3238 @end deffn
3239
3240 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3241 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3242 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3243 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3244 @end deffn
3245
3246 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3247 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3248 @end deffn
3249
3250 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3251 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3252 @end deffn
3253
3254 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3255 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3256 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3260 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3261 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3262 list can be found in the
3263 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3269 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3270 of the one which is most popular.
3271
3272 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3273
3274 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3275 pinout.
3276
3277 @end deffn
3278
3279
3280 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3281 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3282 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3283
3284 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287
3288 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3289 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3290 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3291
3292 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3293 @end deffn
3294
3295
3296 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3297 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3298 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3299
3300 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3301 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3302 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3303
3304 @itemize @minus
3305 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3306 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3307 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3308 @end itemize
3309 @end deffn
3310
3311 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3312 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3313 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3314 @end deffn
3315 @end deffn
3316
3317
3318 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3319 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3320 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3321 DPI server interface.
3322
3323 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3324 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3328 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3329 @end deffn
3330 @end deffn
3331
3332
3333 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3334
3335 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3336 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3337
3338 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3339 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3340
3341 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3342 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3343 @example
3344 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3345 @end example
3346 @end deffn
3347
3348 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3349 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3350 @example
3351 buspirate speed normal
3352 @end example
3353 @end deffn
3354
3355 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3356 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3357 @itemize @minus
3358 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3359 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3360 @end itemize
3361 For example:
3362 @example
3363 buspirate mode normal
3364 @end example
3365 @end deffn
3366
3367 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3368 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3369 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3370 For example:
3371 @example
3372 buspirate pullup 0
3373 @end example
3374 @end deffn
3375
3376 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3377 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3378 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3379 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3380 @example
3381 buspirate vreg 0
3382 @end example
3383 @end deffn
3384
3385 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3386 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3387 @end deffn
3388 @example
3389 buspirate led 1
3390 @end example
3391
3392 @end deffn
3393
3394
3395 @section Transport Configuration
3396 @cindex Transport
3397 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3398 and the debug adapter you are using,
3399 several transports may be available to
3400 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3401 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3402 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3403 version of OpenOCD.
3404 @end deffn
3405
3406 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3407 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3408
3409 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3410 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3411 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3412 adapter's driver).
3413
3414 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3415 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3416 supported by the debug adapter.
3417
3418 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3419 transport, if any.
3420 @end deffn
3421
3422 @subsection JTAG Transport
3423 @cindex JTAG
3424 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3425 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3426 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3427 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3428 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3429 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3430
3431 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3432 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3433 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3434 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3435 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3436
3437 @subsection SWD Transport
3438 @cindex SWD
3439 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3440 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3441 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3442 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3443 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3444 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3445 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3446
3447 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3448 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3449 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3450 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3451 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3452
3453 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3454 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3455 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3456 expected to change.
3457 @end deffn
3458
3459 @subsection SPI Transport
3460 @cindex SPI
3461 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3462 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3463 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3464 solution for flash programming.
3465
3466 @anchor{swimtransport}
3467 @subsection SWIM Transport
3468 @cindex SWIM
3469 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3470 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3471 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3472 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3473
3474 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3475
3476 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3477
3478 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3479 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3480 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3481 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3482 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3483
3484 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3485 @section JTAG Speed
3486 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3487 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3488 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3489 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3490 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3491 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3492 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3493 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3494 power management software that may be active.
3495
3496 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3497 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3498 target event handler.
3499 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3500 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3501 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3502 sets up those clocks).
3503 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3504 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3505 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3506 in the target config file.
3507 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3508 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3509 config file instead.
3510 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3511 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3512 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3513
3514 @example
3515 jtag_rclk 3000
3516 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3517 @end example
3518
3519 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3520 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3521 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3522 may not be the fastest solution.
3523
3524 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3525 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3526 which support adaptive clocking.
3527
3528 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3529 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3530 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3531 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3532 than the speed specified.
3533
3534 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3535 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3536 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3537 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3538
3539 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3540 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3541 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3542 JTAG clocking after setup.
3543 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3544 If the interface device can not
3545 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3546 @end deffn
3547
3548 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3549 @cindex adaptive clocking
3550 @cindex RTCK
3551 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3552 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3553 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3554 @example
3555 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3556 jtag_rclk 3000
3557 @end example
3558 @end defun
3559
3560 @node Reset Configuration
3561 @chapter Reset Configuration
3562 @cindex Reset Configuration
3563
3564 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3565 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3566 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3567 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3568 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3569 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3570 Please see the various board files for examples.
3571
3572 @quotation Note
3573 To maintainers and integrators:
3574 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3575 Normally the board configuration file
3576 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3577 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3578
3579 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3580 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3581 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3582 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3583 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3584 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3585 @end quotation
3586
3587 @section Types of Reset
3588
3589 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3590 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3591 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3592
3593 @itemize @bullet
3594 @item
3595 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3596 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3597 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3598 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3599 @item
3600 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3601 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3602 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3603 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3604 @item
3605 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3606 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3607 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3608 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3609 @item
3610 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3611 several other types of reset.
3612 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3613 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3614 There may be individual module resets.
3615 @end itemize
3616
3617 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3618 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3619 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3620 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3621 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3622 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3623 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3624 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3625 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3626
3627 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3628 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3629
3630 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3631 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3632 common issues are:
3633
3634 @itemize @bullet
3635
3636 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3637 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3638 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3639 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3640 when either of those signals is not connected.
3641 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3642 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3643 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3644 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3645
3646 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3647 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3648 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3649 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3650
3651 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3652 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3653 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3654 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3655 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3656 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3657 hardware debouncing.
3658 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3659 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3660
3661 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3662 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3663 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3664 to use push/pull output drivers.
3665 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3666 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3667 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3668 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3669
3670 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3671 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3672 issues (not limited to errata).
3673 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3674 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3675 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3676 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3677 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3678 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3679 @end itemize
3680
3681 There can also be other issues.
3682 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3683 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3684 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3685 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3686 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3687 Agreement (NDA).
3688
3689 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3690 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3691 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3692
3693 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3694 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3695
3696 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3697
3698 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3699 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3700 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3701 allowing it to be deasserted.
3702 @end deffn
3703
3704 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3705 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3706 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3707 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3708 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3709 @end deffn
3710
3711 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3712 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3713 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3714 allowing it to be deasserted.
3715 @end deffn
3716
3717 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3718 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3719 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3720 @end deffn
3721
3722 @anchor{reset_config}
3723 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3724 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3725 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3726 configuration scripts.
3727
3728 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3729 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3730 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3731 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3732 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3733 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3734 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3735 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3736
3737 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3738 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3739 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3740 -- may be specified at a time.
3741 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3742 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3743 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3744 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3745 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3746
3747 @itemize
3748 @item
3749 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3750 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3751 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3752 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3753 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3754
3755 @quotation Tip
3756 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3757 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3758 @end quotation
3759
3760 @item
3761 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3762 signal implementations.
3763 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3764 indicating everything behaves normally.
3765 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3766 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3767 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3768 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3769 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3770 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3771 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3772
3773 @item
3774 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3775 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3776 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3777 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3778 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3779 while SRST is asserted.
3780 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3781 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3782
3783 @item
3784 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3785 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3786 is required to use this option.
3787 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3788 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3789 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3790 be asserted before any target connection.
3791 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3792 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3793 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3794 @end itemize
3795
3796 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3797 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3798 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3799 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3800 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3801
3802 @itemize
3803 @item
3804 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3805 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3806 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3807 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3808
3809 @item
3810 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3811 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3812 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3813 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3814 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3815 @end itemize
3816 @end deffn
3817
3818 @section Custom Reset Handling
3819 @cindex events
3820
3821 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3822 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3823 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3824 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3825 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3826 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3827
3828 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3829 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3830 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3831 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3832 want to reset everything at once.
3833
3834 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3835 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3836 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3837 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3838 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3839 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3840 needs special attention.
3841
3842 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3843 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3844 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3845 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3846 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3847 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3848 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3849 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3850 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3851
3852 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3853 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3854 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3855 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3856 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3857
3858 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3859 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3860 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3861 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3862 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3863 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3864 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3865 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3866 or potentially some other value.
3867
3868 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3869 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3870 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3871 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3872 (or their associated targets)
3873 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3874
3875 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3876 they return.
3877 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3878 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3879 @end deffn
3880
3881 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3882 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3883 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3884 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3885 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3886 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3887 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3888 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3889 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3890 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3891 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3892 @end deffn
3893
3894 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3895 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3896 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3897 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3898 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3899 @end deffn
3900
3901
3902 @node TAP Declaration
3903 @chapter TAP Declaration
3904 @cindex TAP declaration
3905 @cindex TAP configuration
3906
3907 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3908 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3909
3910 @itemize @bullet
3911 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3912 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3913 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3914 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3915 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3916 start running that code.
3917 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3918 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3919 and missing connections.
3920 @end itemize
3921
3922 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3923 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3924 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3925 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3926 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3927
3928 @section Scan Chains
3929 @cindex scan chain
3930
3931 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3932 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3933 They also need to be added to
3934 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3935 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3936 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3937 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3938 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3939 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3940 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3941 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3942
3943 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3944 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3945 command, presented in the next chapter.
3946 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3947 debugging targets.)
3948 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3949
3950 @verbatim
3951 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3952 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3953 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3954 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3955 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3956 @end verbatim
3957
3958 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3959 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3960 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3961 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3962 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3963 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3964 until they are told to do so.
3965
3966 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3967 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3968 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3969 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3970
3971 @example
3972 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3973 @end example
3974
3975 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3976 by a given chip.
3977 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3978 and so forth.
3979 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3980 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3981 both inside a single chip and between them.
3982 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3983
3984 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3985 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3986 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3987 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3988 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3989 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3990 includes commands something like this:
3991
3992 @example
3993 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3994 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3995 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3996 @end example
3997
3998 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3999 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4000 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4001
4002 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4003 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4004 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4005 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4006 @example
4007 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4008 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4009 @}
4010 @end example
4011 @end deffn
4012
4013 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4014 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4015 and their status.
4016 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4017 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4018 but systems with a JTAG router can
4019 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4020 @end deffn
4021
4022 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4023 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4024
4025 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4026 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4027
4028 @section TAP Names
4029 @cindex dotted name
4030
4031 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4032 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4033 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4034 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4035 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4036 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4037 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4038 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4039
4040 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4041 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4042 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4043
4044 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4045
4046 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4047 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4048 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4049
4050 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4051 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4052 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4053 overridable.
4054
4055 @cindex TAP naming convention
4056 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4057 and should follow this convention:
4058
4059 @itemize @bullet
4060 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4061 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4062 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4063 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4064 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4065 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4066 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4067 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4068 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4069 with a single TAP;
4070 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4071 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4072 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4073 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4074 @end itemize
4075
4076 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4077
4078 @itemize @bullet
4079 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4080 @*The length in bits of the
4081 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4082 @end itemize
4083
4084 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4085
4086 @itemize @bullet
4087 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4088 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4089 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4090 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4091 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4092 (the TAP is linked in).
4093 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4094 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4095 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4096 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4097 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4098 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4099 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4100 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4101 values that were found but not included in the list.
4102
4103 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4104 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4105 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4106 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4107 hardware to find these values.
4108 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4109 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4110 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4111 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4112 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4113 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4114 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4115 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4116 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4117 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4118 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4119 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4120 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4121 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4122 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4123 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4124 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4125 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4126 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4127 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4128 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4129 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4130 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4131 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4132 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4133 @end itemize
4134 @end deffn
4135
4136 @section Other TAP commands
4137
4138 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4139 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4140 @end deffn
4141
4142 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4143 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4144 At this writing this TAP attribute
4145 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4146 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4147 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4148 See the next section for information about the available events.
4149
4150 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4151 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4152 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4153 @end deffn
4154
4155 @section TAP Events
4156 @cindex events
4157 @cindex TAP events
4158
4159 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4160 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4161 The other applies to debugger targets,
4162 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4163
4164 The TAP events currently defined are:
4165
4166 @itemize @bullet
4167 @item @b{post-reset}
4168 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4169 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4170 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4171 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4172 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4173
4174 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4175 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4176 of any particular target.
4177 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4178 @item @b{setup}
4179 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4180 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4181 @item @b{tap-disable}
4182 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4183 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4184 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4185 @item @b{tap-enable}
4186 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4187 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4188 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4189 @end itemize
4190
4191 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4192 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4193 contents to be accurate), you might:
4194
4195 @example
4196 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4197 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4198 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4199 @}
4200 @end example
4201
4202
4203 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4204 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4205 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4206 @cindex jrc
4207
4208 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4209 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4210 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4211 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4212 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4213
4214 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4215 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4216 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4217 be visible.
4218 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4219 ignores, such as:
4220
4221 @itemize
4222 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4223 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4224 TAPs receive new instructions.
4225 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4226 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4227 @end itemize
4228
4229 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4230 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4231 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4232 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4233
4234 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4235 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4236
4237 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4238 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4239 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4240 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4241 should define TAP event handlers using
4242 code that looks something like this:
4243
4244 @example
4245 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4246 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4247 @}
4248 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4249 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4250 @}
4251 @end example
4252
4253 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4254
4255 @example
4256 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4257 @end example
4258
4259 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4260 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4261 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4262 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4263
4264 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4265 If necessary, disables the tap
4266 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4267 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4268 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4269 and "0" if it is disabled.
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4273 If necessary, enables the tap
4274 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4275 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4276 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4277 and "0" if it is disabled.
4278 @end deffn
4279
4280 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4281 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4282 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4283 and "0" if it is disabled.
4284
4285 @quotation Note
4286 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4287 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4288 @end quotation
4289 @end deffn
4290
4291 @anchor{autoprobing}
4292 @section Autoprobing
4293 @cindex autoprobe
4294 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4295
4296 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4297 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4298 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4299 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4300
4301 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4302 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4303 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4304 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4305 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4306 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4307 right when they come out of reset).
4308
4309 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4310
4311 @example
4312 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4313 reset_config trst_and_srst
4314 jtag_rclk 8
4315 @end example
4316
4317 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4318 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4319
4320 @enumerate
4321 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4322 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4323 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4324 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4325 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4326 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4327 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4328 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4329 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4330 that is discovered.
4331 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4332 register, it will report it.
4333 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4334 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4335 @end enumerate
4336
4337 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4338 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4339 that's a bit more complex:
4340
4341 @example
4342 clock speed 8 kHz
4343 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4344 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4345 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4346 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4347 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4348 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4349 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4350 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4351 @end example
4352
4353 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4354 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4355 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4356 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4357 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4358 and so forth.
4359
4360 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4361 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4362 @cindex DAP declaration
4363
4364 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4365 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4366 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4367 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4368 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4369
4370 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4371
4372 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4373 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4374 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4375 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4376 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4377
4378 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4379
4380 @itemize @bullet
4381 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4382 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4383 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4384 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4385 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4386
4387 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4388 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4389 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4390 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4391 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4392 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4393
4394 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4395 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4396 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4397 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4398 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4399 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4400 @end itemize
4401 @end deffn
4402
4403 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4404 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4405 for TCL scripting.
4406 @end deffn
4407
4408 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4409 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4410 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4411 @end deffn
4412
4413 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4414 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4415 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4416 initialization, too.
4417 @end deffn
4418
4419 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4420
4421 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4422 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4423 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4424 @end deffn
4425
4426 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4427 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4428 @end deffn
4429
4430 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4431 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4432 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4433 or set a new value @var{value}.
4434 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4435 @end deffn
4436
4437 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4438 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4439 @end deffn
4440
4441 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4442 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4443 value @var{value}.
4444
4445 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4446 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4447 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4448
4449 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4450 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4451 @end deffn
4452
4453 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4454 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4455 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4456 @end deffn
4457
4458 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4459 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4460 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4461 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4462 @end deffn
4463
4464 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4465 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4466
4467 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4468 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4469 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4470 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4471 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4472 for details.
4473
4474 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4475 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4476 the pattern:
4477 @example
4478 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4479 @end example
4480
4481 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4482 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4483 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4484 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4485 @example
4486 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4487 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4488 @end example
4489
4490 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4491 @example
4492 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4493 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4494 @end example
4495
4496 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4497 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4498
4499 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4500 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4501 example with a proper dap name:
4502 @example
4503 xxx.dap apcsw default
4504 @end example
4505 @end deffn
4506
4507 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4508 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4509 Disabled by default
4510 @end deffn
4511
4512
4513 @node CPU Configuration
4514 @chapter CPU Configuration
4515 @cindex GDB target
4516
4517 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4518 You can also access these targets without GDB
4519 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4520 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4521 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4522 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4523
4524 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4525 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4526
4527 @section Target List
4528 @cindex target, current
4529 @cindex target, list
4530
4531 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4532 where each member has a name.
4533 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4534 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4535 (plural!) command.
4536 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4537 look like with more than one:
4538 @verbatim
4539 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4540 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4541 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4542 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4543 @end verbatim
4544
4545 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4546 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4547 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4548 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4549 space seen by that current target.
4550 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4551 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4552 are examples; and there are many more.
4553
4554 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4555
4556 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4557 Returns the name of the current target.
4558 @end deffn
4559
4560 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4561 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4562 @example
4563 foreach t [target names] @{
4564 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4565 @}
4566 @end example
4567 @end deffn
4568
4569 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4570 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4571
4572 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4573 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4574 command names are singular.}
4575
4576 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4577 targets in a user friendly form.
4578
4579 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4580 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4581 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4582 @end deffn
4583
4584 @section Target CPU Types
4585 @cindex target type
4586 @cindex CPU type
4587
4588 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4589 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4590 when calling @command{target create}.
4591 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4592 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4593 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4594 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4595 what core-specific commands may be available
4596 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4597 and more.
4598
4599 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4600 since there's a command to list them.
4601
4602 @anchor{targettypes}
4603 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4604 Lists all supported target types.
4605 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4606
4607 @itemize @bullet
4608 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4609 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4610 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4611 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4612 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4613 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4614 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4615 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4616 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4617 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4618 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4619 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4620 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4621 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4622 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4623 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4624 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4625 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4626 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4627 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4628 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4629 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4630 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4631 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4632 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4633 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4634 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4635 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4636 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4637 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4638 support for new CPUs.
4639 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4640 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4641 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4642 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4643 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4644 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4645 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4646 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4647 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4648 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4649 @itemize @minus
4650 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4651 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4652 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4653 @end itemize
4654 And two debug interfaces cores:
4655 @itemize @minus
4656 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4657 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4658 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4659 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4660 @end itemize
4661 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4662 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4663 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4664 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4665 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4666 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4667 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4668 @end itemize
4669 @end deffn
4670
4671 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4672 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4673 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4674 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4675 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4676 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4677 reflect design generations;
4678 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4679 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4680
4681 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4682 @section Target Configuration
4683
4684 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4685 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4686 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4687 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4688 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4689
4690 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4691 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4692 optional parts.
4693 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4694 command, created as part of target creation.
4695
4696 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4697 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4698 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4699 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4700 to be much more board-specific.
4701 The key steps you use might look something like this
4702
4703 @example
4704 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4705 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4706 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4707 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4708 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4709 @end example
4710
4711 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4712 on-chip SRAM.
4713 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4714 writes to target memory;
4715 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4716 GDB memory checksumming;
4717 and more.
4718
4719 @quotation Warning
4720 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4721 inaccessible when application code
4722 (such as an operating system)
4723 enables or disables the MMU.
4724 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4725 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4726 easy access to other addresses needed.
4727 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4728 @end quotation
4729
4730 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4731 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4732 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4733 controllers.
4734 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4735 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4736 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4737
4738 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4739 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4740 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4741 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4742 purposes including additional configuration.
4743
4744 @itemize @bullet
4745 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4746 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4747 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4748 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4749
4750 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4751 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4752 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4753 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4754 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4755 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4756 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4757
4758 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4759 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4760 @end itemize
4761 @end deffn
4762
4763 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4764 The options accepted by this command may also be
4765 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4766 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4767 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4768
4769 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4770 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4771 and changing its endianness.
4772
4773 @itemize @bullet
4774
4775 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4776 used to access this target.
4777
4778 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4779 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4780 create and manage DAP instances.
4781
4782 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4783 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4784
4785 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4786 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4787 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4788 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4789 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4790 same event name assigns only one handler.
4791
4792 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4793 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4794
4795 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4796 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4797 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4798 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4799 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4800 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4801 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4802
4803 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4804 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4805 or virtual address is being used.
4806
4807 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4808 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4809
4810 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4811 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4812 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4813 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4814 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4815
4816 @anchor{rtostype}
4817 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4818 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4819 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4820 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4821 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4822 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4823
4824 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4825 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4826 access the target for debugging.
4827
4828 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4829 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4830 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4831 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4832
4833 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4834 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4835 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4836 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4837 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4838
4839 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4840 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4841 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4842 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4843 command @command{gdb_port}.
4844 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4845
4846 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4847 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4848 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4849 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4850 @end itemize
4851 @end deffn
4852
4853 @section Other $target_name Commands
4854 @cindex object command
4855
4856 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4857 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4858
4859 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4860 Once a button is created a button
4861 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4862 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4863 configure it like this:
4864
4865 @example
4866 # Create
4867 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4868 # Modify
4869 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4870 # Query
4871 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4872 # Report
4873 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4874 @end example
4875
4876 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4877 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4878
4879 @example
4880 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4881 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4882 @end example
4883
4884 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4885
4886 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4887 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4888 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4889 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4890 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4891 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4892 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4893 They are not otherwise documented here.
4894 @end deffn
4895
4896 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4897 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4898 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4899 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4900 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4901 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4902 the target side uses raw memory.
4903
4904 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4905 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4906 The script orientation comes from working with data
4907 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4908 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4909 and neither store nor return those values.
4910
4911 @itemize
4912 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4913 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4914 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4915 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4916 @end itemize
4917 @end deffn
4918
4919 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4920 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4921 @command{$target_name configure}
4922 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4923 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4924 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4925 There are a few special cases:
4926
4927 @itemize @bullet
4928 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4929 event named @var{event_name}.
4930 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4931 two parameters.
4932 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4933 This is a special case because this is set using
4934 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4935 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4936 @end itemize
4937
4938 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4939 all the targets you might use something like this:
4940
4941 @example
4942 foreach name [target names] @{
4943 set y [$name cget -endian]
4944 set z [$name cget -type]
4945 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4946 $x $name $y $z]
4947 @}
4948 @end example
4949 @end deffn
4950
4951 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4952 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4953 Displays the current target state:
4954 @code{debug-running},
4955 @code{halted},
4956 @code{reset},
4957 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4958 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4959 @end deffn
4960
4961 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4962 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4963 currently associated with this target.
4964 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4965 @end deffn
4966
4967 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4968 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4969 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4970 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4971 @end deffn
4972
4973 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4974 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4975 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4976 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4977 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4978 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4979 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4980 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4981 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4982 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4983 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4984 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4985 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4986 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4987 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4988 @end deffn
4989
4990 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4991 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4992 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4993 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4994 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4995 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4996 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4997 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4998 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4999 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5000 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5001 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5002 @end deffn
5003
5004 @anchor{targetevents}
5005 @section Target Events
5006 @cindex target events
5007 @cindex events
5008 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5009 For example:
5010 @itemize @bullet
5011 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5012 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5013 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5014 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5015 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5016 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5017 to set up system clocks or
5018 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5019 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5020 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5021 @end itemize
5022
5023 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5024 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5025 @command{target create ... -event}.
5026
5027 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5028 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5029 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5030
5031 @example
5032 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5033 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5034 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5035 @}
5036 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5037 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5038 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5039 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5040 @}
5041 @end example
5042
5043 The following target events are defined:
5044
5045 @itemize @bullet
5046 @item @b{debug-halted}
5047 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5048 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5049 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5050 @item @b{early-halted}
5051 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5052 @item @b{examine-start}
5053 @* Before target examine is called.
5054 @item @b{examine-end}
5055 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5056 @item @b{examine-fail}
5057 @* After target examine fails.
5058 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5059 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5060 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5061 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5062 connect GDB to running target.
5063 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5064 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5065 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5066 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5067 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5068 is in RAM or read only memory.
5069 Default is @code{halt}
5070 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5071 @* When GDB disconnects
5072 @item @b{gdb-end}
5073 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5074 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5075 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5076 @code{reset init})
5077 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5078 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5079 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5080 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5081 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5082 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5083 @item @b{gdb-start}
5084 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5085 @item @b{halted}
5086 @* The target has halted
5087 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5088 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5089 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5090 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5091 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5092 @item @b{reset-assert}
5093 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5094 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5095 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5096 it instead of asserting SRST.
5097 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5098 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5099 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5100 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5101 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5102 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5103 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5104 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5105 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5106 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5107 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5108 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5109 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5110 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5111 released on the scan chain.
5112 @item @b{reset-end}
5113 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5114 @item @b{reset-init}
5115 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5116 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5117
5118 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5119 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5120 multiplexing, and so on.
5121 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5122 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5123 @item @b{reset-start}
5124 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5125 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5126
5127 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5128 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5129 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5130 @item @b{resume-start}
5131 @* Before any target is resumed
5132 @item @b{resume-end}
5133 @* After all targets have resumed
5134 @item @b{resumed}
5135 @* Target has resumed
5136 @item @b{step-start}
5137 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5138 @item @b{step-end}
5139 @* After single-step has completed
5140 @item @b{trace-config}
5141 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5142 @end itemize
5143
5144 @quotation Note
5145 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5146 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5147 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5148 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5149 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5150 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5151 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5152 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5153 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5154 check if the core has changed status.
5155 @end quotation
5156
5157 @node Flash Commands
5158 @chapter Flash Commands
5159
5160 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5161 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5162 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5163 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5164 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5165 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5166 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5167 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5168 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5169
5170 Flash Steps:
5171 @enumerate
5172 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5173 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5174 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5175 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5176 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5177 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5178 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5179 @item GDB Flashing
5180 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5181 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5182 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5183 @end enumerate
5184
5185 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5186 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5187 so that it can't boot.
5188 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5189 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5190
5191 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5192 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5193 @cindex flash configuration
5194
5195 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5196 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5197 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5198 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5199 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5200 see the driver-specific documentation.
5201
5202 @itemize @bullet
5203 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5204 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5205 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5206 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5207 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5208 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5209 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5210 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5211 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5212 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5213 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5214 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5215 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5216 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5217 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5218 commands to the flash controller.
5219 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5220 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5221 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5222 for more information.
5223 @end itemize
5224 @quotation Note
5225 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5226 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5227 @end quotation
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5231 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5232 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5233 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5234 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5235 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5236 @end deffn
5237
5238 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5239 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5240 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5241 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5242 @end deffn
5243
5244 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5245 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5246 depends on the flash type.
5247 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5248 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5249 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5250 but most don't bother.
5251 @end deffn
5252
5253 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5254
5255 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5256 begins.
5257
5258 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5259 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5260 until the programming session is finished.
5261
5262 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5263 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5264
5265 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5266
5267 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5268 @cindex flash erasing
5269 @cindex flash reading
5270 @cindex flash writing
5271 @cindex flash programming
5272 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5273
5274 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5275 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5276 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5277 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5278 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5279
5280 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5281 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5282 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5283 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5284 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5285
5286 @quotation Note
5287 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5288 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5289 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5290 back to a flash bank.
5291 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5292 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5293 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5294 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5295 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5296 @end quotation
5297
5298 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5299 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5300 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5301 disabled first.
5302 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5303 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5304 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5305
5306 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5307 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5308 up to and including @var{last}.
5309 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5310 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5311 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5312 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5313 @end deffn
5314
5315 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5316 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5317 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5318 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5319 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5320 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5321 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5322 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5323 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5324 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5325 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5326 before erase starts.
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5330 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5331 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5332 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5333 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5334 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5335 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5336 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5337 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5338 before issuing this command.
5339 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5340 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5341 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5342 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5343 @end deffn
5344 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5345
5346 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5347 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5348 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5349 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5350 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5351 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5352 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5353 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5354 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5355 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5356 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5357 @end deffn
5358
5359 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5360 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5361 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5362 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5363 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5364 @end deffn
5365
5366 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5367 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5368 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5369 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5370 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5371 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5372 @end deffn
5373
5374 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5375 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5376 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5377 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5378 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5379 @end deffn
5380
5381 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5382 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5383 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5384 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5385 to the base address for each section in the image.
5386 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5387 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5388 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5389 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5390 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5391 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5392 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5393 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5394 each image section.
5395
5396 @quotation Warning
5397 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5398 data you want to preserve.
5399 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5400 sections might be erased with no notice.
5401 @itemize
5402 @item
5403 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5404 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5405 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5406 @item
5407 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5408 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5409 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5410 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5411 @end itemize
5412 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5413 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5414 @end quotation
5415
5416 @end deffn
5417
5418 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5419 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5420 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5421 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5422 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5423 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5424 ordinary memory reads.
5425 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5426 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5427 check for successful programming.
5428 @end deffn
5429
5430 @section Other Flash commands
5431 @cindex flash protection
5432
5433 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5434 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5435 and display that status.
5436 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5437 @end deffn
5438
5439 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5440 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5441 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5442
5443 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5444 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5445 and possibly stale information.
5446 @end deffn
5447
5448 @anchor{flashprotect}
5449 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5450 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5451 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5452 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5453 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5454 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5455 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5456 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5457 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5458 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5459 @end deffn
5460
5461 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5462 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5463 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5464 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5465 @end deffn
5466
5467 @anchor{program}
5468 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5469 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5470 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5471 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5472 @end deffn
5473
5474 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5475 @section Flash Driver List
5476 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5477 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5478 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5479
5480 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5481 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5482 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5483
5484 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5485
5486 @itemize
5487 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5488 @end itemize
5489
5490 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5491 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5492 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5493 @example
5494 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5495 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5496 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5497 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5498 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5499 @end example
5500 @end deffn
5501
5502 @subsection External Flash
5503
5504 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5505 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5506 @cindex CFI
5507 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5508 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5509 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5510 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5511 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5512 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5513 configure a bus and its timings), or
5514 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5515 on the flash chip.
5516 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5517 speed up operation.
5518
5519 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5520
5521 @itemize
5522 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5523 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5524 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5525 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5526 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5527 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5528 @end itemize
5529
5530 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5531 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5532
5533 @example
5534 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5535 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5536 @end example
5537
5538 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5539 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5540 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5541
5542 @example
5543 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5544 @end example
5545
5546 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5547 @end deffn
5548
5549 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5550 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5551 @cindex SPI
5552 @cindex jtagspi
5553 @cindex bscan_spi
5554 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5555 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5556 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5557 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5558 accessed through JTAG.
5559
5560 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5561 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5562 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5563 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5564 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5565 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5566
5567 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5568 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5569 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5570 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5571 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5572 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5573 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5574 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5575
5576 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5577 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5578 command, see below.
5579
5580 @itemize
5581 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5582 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5583 @var{USER1} instruction.
5584 @end itemize
5585
5586 @example
5587 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5588 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5589 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5590 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5591 @end example
5592
5593 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5594 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5595 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5596 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5597 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5598 @example
5599 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5600 @end example
5601 @end deffn
5602
5603 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5604 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5605 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5606 @example
5607 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5608 @end example
5609 @end deffn
5610
5611 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5612 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5613 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5614 @end deffn
5615 @end deffn
5616
5617 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5618 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5619 @cindex xcf
5620 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5621 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5622 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5623 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5624 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5625
5626 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5627 command accepts additional parameters:
5628 @itemize
5629 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5630 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5631 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5632 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5633 in master mode.
5634 @end itemize
5635 @example
5636 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5637 @end example
5638 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5639 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5640 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5641 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5642 dedicated sector.
5643 @end deffn
5644
5645 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5646 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5647 button.
5648 @example
5649 xcf configure 0
5650 @end example
5651 @end deffn
5652
5653 Additional driver notes:
5654 @itemize
5655 @item Only single revision supported.
5656 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5657 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5658 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5659 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5660 @end itemize
5661 @end deffn
5662
5663 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5664 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5665 @cindex SPIFI
5666 @cindex lpcspifi
5667 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5668 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5669 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5670
5671 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5672 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5673 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5674 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5675 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5676
5677 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5678 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5679 are configured by the driver.
5680
5681 @example
5682 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5683 @end example
5684
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5688 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5689 @cindex SMI
5690 @cindex stmsmi
5691 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5692 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5693 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5694 SPI flash devices.
5695 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5696 flash devices can be connected.
5697
5698 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5699 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5700 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5701 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5702 the flash content.
5703
5704 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5705 to identify the memory bank.
5706 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5707 flash size, are detected automatically.
5708
5709 @example
5710 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5711 @end example
5712
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5716 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5717 @cindex QuadSPI
5718 @cindex OctoSPI
5719 @cindex stmqspi
5720 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5721 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5722 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5723 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5724 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5725 mode is not.
5726
5727 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5728 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5729 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5730 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5731
5732 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5733 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5734 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5735
5736 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5737 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5738 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5739 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5740 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5741 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5742
5743 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5744 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5745 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5746 should be avoided.
5747
5748 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5749 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5750 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5751 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5752 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5753 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5754
5755 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5756 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5757 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5758 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5759 persist across openocd invocations.
5760
5761 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5762 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5763 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5764 required (see 'set' command).
5765
5766 @example
5767 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5768 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5770 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5771 @end example
5772
5773 There are three specific commands
5774 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5775 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5776 chip specific write protection engaged.
5777 @end deffn
5778
5779 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5780 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5781 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5782 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5783 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5784 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5785
5786 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5787 which don't support an id command.
5788
5789 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5790 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5794 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5795 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5796 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5797 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5798
5799 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5800 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5801 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5802 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5803
5804 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5805
5806 To check basic communication settings, issue
5807 @example
5808 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5809 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5810 @end example
5811 for single flash mode or
5812 @example
5813 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5814 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5815 @end example
5816 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5817
5818 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5819 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5820 need a dummy address, e.g.
5821 @example
5822 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5823 @end example
5824 should return the status register contents.
5825
5826 @end deffn
5827
5828 @end deffn
5829
5830 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5831 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5832 Microcontroller platform.
5833
5834 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5835 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5836
5837 @example
5838 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5839 @end example
5840
5841 @end deffn
5842
5843 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5844 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5845 @cindex ath79
5846 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5847 chip selects.
5848 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5849 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5850 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5851 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5852 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5853 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5854
5855 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5856 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5857 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5858 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5859 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5860 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5861 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5862 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5863 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5864 with the default CS0.
5865 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5866 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5867 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5868
5869 @example
5870 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5871
5872 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5873 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5874 # distinguish the banks.
5875 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5876 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5877 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5878 @end example
5879
5880 @end deffn
5881
5882 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5883 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5884 @cindex fespi
5885
5886 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5887
5888 @example
5889 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5890 @end example
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5894
5895 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5896 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5897 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5898 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5899 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5900 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5901
5902 @example
5903 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5904 @end example
5905 @end deffn
5906
5907 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5908 @cindex ambiqmicro
5909 @cindex apollo
5910 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5911 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5912 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5913 with the target using SWD.
5914
5915 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5916 the device class of the MCU.
5917 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5918 to set up the flash banks.
5919 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5920 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5921
5922 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5923 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5924 and the second bank starts after the first.
5925
5926 @example
5927 # Flash bank 0
5928 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5929 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5931 $_TARGETNAME
5932 @end example
5933
5934 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5935 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5936 are available to the user.
5937
5938 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5939
5940 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5941 Erase entire bank.
5942 @end deffn
5943 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5944 Erase device pages.
5945 @end deffn
5946 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5947 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5948 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5949 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5950 the flash.
5951 @end deffn
5952 @end deffn
5953
5954 @anchor{at91samd}
5955 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5956 @cindex at91samd
5957 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5958 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5959
5960 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5961
5962 The devices have one flash bank:
5963
5964 @example
5965 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5966 @end example
5967
5968 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5969 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5970 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5971 processor to be halted.
5972 @end deffn
5973
5974 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5975 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5976 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5977 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5978 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5979 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5980
5981 @example
5982 at91samd set-security enable
5983 @end example
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5987 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5988 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5989 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5990 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5991 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5992 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5993 in order to disable this feature.
5994
5995 @example
5996 at91samd eeprom
5997 at91samd eeprom 1024
5998 @end example
5999 @end deffn
6000
6001 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6002 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6003 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6004 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6005 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6006 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6007
6008 @example
6009 at91samd bootloader
6010 at91samd bootloader 16384
6011 @end example
6012 @end deffn
6013
6014 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6015 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6016 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6017 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6018 @end deffn
6019
6020 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6021 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6022 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6023 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6024 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6025 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6026 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6027 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6028
6029 @example
6030 # Read user row
6031 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6032 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6033 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6034 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6035 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6036 # byte unchanged
6037 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6038 @end example
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @end deffn
6042
6043 @anchor{at91sam3}
6044 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6045 @cindex at91sam3
6046 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6047 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6048 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6049 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6050 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6051 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6052 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6053 chips are confirmed.}
6054
6055 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6056 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6057 the following fixed locations:
6058
6059 @example
6060 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6061 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6062 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6063 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6064 @end example
6065
6066 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6067 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6068 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6069
6070 @itemize
6071 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6072 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6073 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6074 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6075 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6076 @end itemize
6077
6078 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6079
6080 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6081 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6082 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6083 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6084 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6085 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6086 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6087
6088 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6089 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6090 @end deffn
6091
6092 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6093 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6094 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6095 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6096 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6097 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6098 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6099 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6100 @end deffn
6101
6102 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6103 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6104 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6105 @end deffn
6106 @end deffn
6107
6108 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6109 @cindex at91sam4
6110 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6111 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6112 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6113 @end deffn
6114
6115 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6116 @cindex at91sam4l
6117 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6118 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6119 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6120
6121 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6122 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6123 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6124 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6125 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6126 @end deffn
6127 @end deffn
6128
6129 @anchor{atsame5}
6130 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6131 @cindex atsame5
6132 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6133 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6134 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6135
6136 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6137 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6138 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6139
6140 @example
6141 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6142 @end example
6143
6144 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6145 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6146 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6147 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6148 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6149 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6150
6151 @example
6152 atsame5 bootloader
6153 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6154 @end example
6155 @end deffn
6156
6157 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6158 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6159 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6160 processor to be halted.
6161 @end deffn
6162
6163 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6164 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6165 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6166 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6167 @end deffn
6168
6169 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6170 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6171 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6172 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6173 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6174 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6175 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6176 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6177
6178 @example
6179 # Read
6180 >atsame5 userpage
6181 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6182 # Write
6183 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6184 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6185 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6186 # bytes)
6187 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6188 @end example
6189 @end deffn
6190
6191 @end deffn
6192
6193 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6194 @cindex atsamv
6195 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6196 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6197 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6198 @end deffn
6199
6200 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6201 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6202 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6203 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6204 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6205
6206 @example
6207 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6208 @end example
6209
6210 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6211 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6212
6213 @itemize
6214 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6215 @item @var{banks}
6216 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6217 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6218 @item @var{pages_size}
6219 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6220 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6221 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6222 @end itemize
6223
6224 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6225 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6226 will be autoconfigured.
6227 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6228
6229 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6230 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6231 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6232 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6233 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6234
6235 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6236 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6237 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6238 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6239 are not truly general purpose).
6240 @quotation Note
6241 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6242 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6243 @end quotation
6244 @end deffn
6245 @end deffn
6246
6247 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6248 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6249 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6250 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6254 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6255 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6256 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6257
6258 @example
6259 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6260 @end example
6261
6262 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6263 each single sector one by one.
6264
6265 @example
6266 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6267 @end example
6268
6269 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6270 @end deffn
6271
6272 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6273 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6274 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6275 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6276 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6277 starts at address 0.
6278
6279 @example
6280 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6281 @end example
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6285 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6286 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6287 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6288 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6289 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6290 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6291 and programming the serial flash.
6292
6293 @example
6294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6295 @end example
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6299 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6300 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6301 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6302 autoconfigures itself.
6303 @example
6304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6305 @end example
6306 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6307 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6308 this via the following command:
6309 @example
6310 efm32 debuglock num
6311 @end example
6312 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6313 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6314 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6315 supported.}
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6319 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6320 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6321 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6322 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6323 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6324
6325 @example
6326 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6327 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6328 @end example
6329
6330 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6331 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6332 @end deffn
6333
6334 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6335 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6336 is an uncommon operation.}
6337 @end deffn
6338 @end deffn
6339
6340 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6341 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6342 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6343 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6344 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6345 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6346 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6347
6348 @example
6349 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6350 @end example
6351 @end deffn
6352
6353 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6354 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6355 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6356 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6357 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6358 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6359 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6360 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6361 characters) ignored.
6362
6363 @example
6364 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6365 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6366 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6367 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6368 @end example
6369 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6370 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6374 @cindex kinetis
6375 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6376 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6377 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6378 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6379 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6380 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6381
6382 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6383 @itemize
6384 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6385 @end itemize
6386
6387 @example
6388 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6389 @end example
6390
6391 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6392 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6393 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6394 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6398 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6399 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6400 set by 'flash protect' command.
6401 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6402 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6403 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6404 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6405 with the rest of a flash image.
6406 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6407 @end deffn
6408
6409 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6410 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6411 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6412 @end deffn
6413
6414 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6415 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6416 and examine-fail event.
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6420 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6421 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6422 @end deffn
6423
6424 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6425 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6426 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6427 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6428 command completes.
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6432 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6433 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6434 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6435 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6436
6437 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6438 Program Partition command.
6439
6440 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6441 Reset the device after partition setting.
6442
6443 Show partition size:
6444 @example
6445 kinetis nvm_partition info
6446 @end example
6447
6448 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6449 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6450 @example
6451 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6452 @end example
6453
6454 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6455 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6456 @example
6457 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6458 @end example
6459 @end deffn
6460
6461 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6462 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6463 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6467 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6468 Command disables watchdog timer.
6469 @end deffn
6470 @end deffn
6471
6472 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6473 @cindex kinetis_ke
6474 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6475 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6476 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6477 autoconfigures itself.
6478 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6479
6480 @example
6481 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6482 @end example
6483
6484 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6485 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6486 @end deffn
6487
6488 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6489 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6490 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6491 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6492 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6493 @end deffn
6494
6495 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6496 Command disables watchdog timer.
6497 @end deffn
6498 @end deffn
6499
6500 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6501 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6502 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6503 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6504 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6505
6506 @quotation Note
6507 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6508 driver:
6509 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6510 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6511 @end quotation
6512
6513 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6514 which must appear in the following order:
6515
6516 @itemize
6517 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6518 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6519 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6520 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6521 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6522 LPC43x[2357])
6523 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6524 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6525 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6526 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6527 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6528 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6529 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6530 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6531 at which the core is running
6532 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6533 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6534 @quotation Note
6535 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6536 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6537 However, if you do provide it,
6538 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6539 @end quotation
6540 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6541 ROM IAP entry point.
6542 @end itemize
6543
6544 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6545
6546 @example
6547 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6548 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6549 @end example
6550
6551 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6552 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6553 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6554 @end deffn
6555 @end deffn
6556
6557 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6558 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6559 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6560 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6561 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6562 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6563
6564 @example
6565 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6566 @end example
6567 @end deffn
6568
6569 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6570 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6571 from NXP.
6572
6573 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6574 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6575 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6576 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6577 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6578 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6579 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6580 you start the PLL.
6581
6582 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6583
6584 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6585 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6586 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6587
6588 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6589 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6590 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6591 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6592 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6593 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6594 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6595
6596 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6597 @example
6598 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6599 @end example
6600
6601 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6602 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6603 @code{flash banks} command.
6604
6605 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6606 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6607 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6608 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6609 a known signature.
6610 Example:
6611 @example
6612 lpc2900 signature 0
6613 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6614 @end example
6615 @end deffn
6616
6617 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6618 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6619 saves it to a file in binary format.
6620 Example:
6621 @example
6622 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6623 @end example
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6627 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6628 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6629 command:
6630
6631 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6632 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6633 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6634 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6635
6636 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6637 Example:
6638 @example
6639 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6640 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6641 @end example
6642 @end deffn
6643
6644 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6645 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6646 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6647 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6648 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6649 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6650 912 bytes.
6651 @quotation Attention
6652 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6653 @end quotation
6654 Example:
6655 @example
6656 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6657 @end example
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6661 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6662 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6663 after the next power cycle.
6664 @quotation Attention
6665 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6666 @end quotation
6667 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6668 Example:
6669 @example
6670 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6671 flash info 0
6672 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6673 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6674 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6675 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6676 @end example
6677 @end deffn
6678
6679 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6680 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6681 effective after the next power cycle.
6682 @quotation Attention
6683 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6684 @end quotation
6685 Examples:
6686 @example
6687 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6688 @end example
6689 @end deffn
6690 @end deffn
6691
6692 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6693 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6694 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6695 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6696
6697 @example
6698 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6699 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6700 @end example
6701
6702 @itemize @bullet
6703 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6704 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6705 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6706 @end itemize
6707
6708 Example usage:
6709 @example
6710 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6711 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6712 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6713 @} else @{
6714 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6715 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6716 @}
6717 @end example
6718 @end deffn
6719
6720 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6721 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6722 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6723 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6724 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6725 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6726
6727 @example
6728 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6729 @end example
6730
6731 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6732 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6733 only the main program flash.
6734
6735 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6736 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6737 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6738 @end deffn
6739
6740 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6741 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6742 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6743 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6744
6745 To erase and program the BSL:
6746 @example
6747 msp432 bsl unlock
6748 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6749 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6750 msp432 bsl lock
6751 @end example
6752 @end deffn
6753 @end deffn
6754
6755 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6756 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6757 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6758 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6759 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6760 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6761 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6762 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6763 also have division into regions: main and info.
6764 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6765 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6766
6767 @example
6768 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6769 @end example
6770
6771 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6772
6773 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6774 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6778 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6779 @end deffn
6780
6781 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6782 Erase all userflash including info region.
6783 @end deffn
6784
6785 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6786 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6790 Check sectors protect.
6791 @end deffn
6792
6793 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6794 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6798 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6799 @end deffn
6800
6801 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6802 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6806 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6807 @end deffn
6808
6809 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6810 Show information about flash driver.
6811 @end deffn
6812
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6816 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6817 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6818 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6819 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6820
6821 @example
6822 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6823 @end example
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6827 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6828 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6829 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6830 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6831
6832 @example
6833 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6834 @end example
6835
6836 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6837
6838 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6839 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6840 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6841 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6842 code.
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6846 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6847 @end deffn
6848
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6852 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6853 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6854
6855 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6856 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6857 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6858 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6859
6860 @example
6861 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6862 @end example
6863 @end deffn
6864
6865 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6866 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6867 and integrate flash memory.
6868
6869 @example
6870 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6871 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6872 @end example
6873
6874 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6875 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6876 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6877 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6878 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6879 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6880 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6881 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6882 @end deffn
6883 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6884 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6885 This will remove any Code Protection.
6886 @end deffn
6887 @end deffn
6888
6889 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6890 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6891 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6892 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6893 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6894
6895 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6896 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6897
6898 @example
6899 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6900 @end example
6901
6902 psoc4-specific commands
6903 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6904 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6905
6906 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6907 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6908
6909 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6910 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6911 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6912
6913 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6914 @end deffn
6915
6916 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6917 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6918
6919 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6920 @end deffn
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6924 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6925 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6926 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6927 apart from the base address.
6928
6929 @example
6930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6931 @end example
6932
6933 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6934 @quotation Attention
6935 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6936 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6937 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6938 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6939 @end quotation
6940
6941 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6942
6943 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6944 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6945 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6946 @end deffn
6947 @end deffn
6948
6949 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6950 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6951 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6952 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6953 apart from the base address.
6954
6955 @example
6956 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6957 $_TARGETNAME
6958 @end example
6959 @end deffn
6960
6961 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6962 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6963 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6964 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6965
6966 @example
6967 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6968 @end example
6969
6970 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6971
6972 @itemize
6973 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6974 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6975 @end itemize
6976
6977 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6978
6979 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6980 @quotation Attention
6981 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6982 after successful write.
6983 @end quotation
6984 @end deffn
6985
6986 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6987 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6988 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6989 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6990
6991 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6992 @itemize @bullet
6993 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6994 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6995 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6996 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6997 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6998 row size: 512 bytes.
6999 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7000 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7001 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7002 operation will erase row automatically.
7003 @end itemize
7004
7005 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7006 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7007
7008 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7009
7010 @example
7011 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7012 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7013 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7014 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7015 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7016 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7017 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7018 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7019 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7020 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7021 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7022 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7023
7024 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7025 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7026 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7027 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7028 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7029 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7030 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7031 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7032 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7033 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7034 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7035 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7036 @end example
7037
7038 psoc6-specific commands
7039 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7040 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7041 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7042 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7043 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7044 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7045 @end deffn
7046
7047 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7048 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7049 by @command{flash banks}.
7050 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7051 @end deffn
7052 @end deffn
7053
7054 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7055 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7056 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7057 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7058 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7059
7060 @example
7061 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7062 @end example
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7066 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7067 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7068 and SWD interface.
7069 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7070 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7071
7072 @example
7073 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7074 @end example
7075
7076 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7077
7078 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7079 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7080 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7081 @end deffn
7082
7083 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7084 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7085 @end deffn
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7089 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7090 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7091 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7092 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7093
7094 @example
7095 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7096 @end example
7097
7098 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7099 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7100 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7101 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7102 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7103 disabled.
7104
7105 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7106 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7107 @quotation Warning
7108 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7109 applied to all of them.
7110 @end quotation
7111 @end deffn
7112 @end deffn
7113
7114 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7115 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7116 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7117 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7118 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7119 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7120
7121 @example
7122 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7123 @end example
7124
7125 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7126 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7127 the flash driver.
7128
7129 @example
7130 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7131 @end example
7132
7133 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7134 as per the following example.
7135 @example
7136 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7137 @end example
7138
7139 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7140
7141 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7142 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7143 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7147 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7148 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7149 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7150 @end deffn
7151
7152 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7153 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7154 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7155 @end deffn
7156
7157 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7158 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7159 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7160 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7164 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7165 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7166 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7167 @end deffn
7168
7169 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7170 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7171 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7172 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7173 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7174 @end deffn
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7178 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7179 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7180 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7181 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7182
7183 @example
7184 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7185 @end example
7186
7187 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7188 as per the following example.
7189 @example
7190 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7191 @end example
7192
7193 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7194 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7195 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7199 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7200 the flash driver.
7201
7202 @example
7203 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7204 @end example
7205
7206 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7207
7208 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7209 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7210 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7214 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7215 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7216 @end deffn
7217
7218 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7219 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7220 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7221 @end deffn
7222
7223 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7224 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7225 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7226 @end deffn
7227
7228 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7229 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7230 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7231 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7232 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7233 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7234 @end deffn
7235
7236 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7237 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7238 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7239 @end deffn
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7243 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7244 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7245 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7246 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7247
7248 @example
7249 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7250 @end example
7251
7252 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7253 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7254 the flash driver.
7255
7256 @example
7257 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7258 @end example
7259
7260 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7261
7262 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7263 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7264 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7265 @end deffn
7266
7267 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7268 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7269 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7273 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7275 @end deffn
7276
7277 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7278 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7279 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7280 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7281 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7282
7283 Example usage:
7284 @example
7285 # read OPTSR_CUR
7286 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7287 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7288 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7289 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7290 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7291 @end example
7292 @end deffn
7293
7294 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7295 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7296 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7297 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7298 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7299 will be touched).
7300
7301 Example usage:
7302 @example
7303 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7304 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7305 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7306 @end example
7307 @end deffn
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7311 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7312 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7313 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7314 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7315
7316 @example
7317 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7318 @end example
7319
7320 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7321 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7322 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7323 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7324 second bank.
7325
7326 @example
7327 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7328 @end example
7329
7330 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7331
7332 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7333 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7334 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7335 @end deffn
7336
7337 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7338 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7339 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7343 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7344 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7345 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7346 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7347 @end deffn
7348 @end deffn
7349
7350 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7351 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7352 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7353 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7354 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7355 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7356
7357 @example
7358 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7359 @end example
7360
7361 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7362 as per the following example.
7363 @example
7364 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7365 @end example
7366
7367 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7368 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7369 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7370 @end deffn
7371
7372 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7373 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7374 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7375 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7376
7377 @example
7378 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7379 @end example
7380
7381 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7382
7383 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7384 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7385 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7386
7387 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7388 @end deffn
7389
7390 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7391 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7392 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7393
7394 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7398 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7399 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7403 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7404 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7405 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7406
7407 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7408 @example
7409 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7410 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7411 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7412 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7413 @end example
7414
7415 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7416 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7420 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7421 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7422 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7423 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7424
7425 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7426
7427 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7428 @example
7429 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7430 @end example
7431
7432 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7433 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7434 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7435 @end deffn
7436
7437 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7438 List the protected areas using WRP.
7439 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7440 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7441 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7442
7443 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7444 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7445 in single or dual-banks mode.
7446 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7447 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7448
7449 @end deffn
7450
7451 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7452 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7453 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7457 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7458 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7459 the TrustZone status.
7460 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7461 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7462 @end deffn
7463 @end deffn
7464
7465 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7466 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7467 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7468 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7469 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7470
7471 @example
7472 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7473 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7474 @end example
7475
7476 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7477 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7478 for the specified flash bank.
7479 @end deffn
7480 @end deffn
7481
7482 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7483 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7484 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7485 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7486 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7487
7488 @example
7489 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7490 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7491 @end example
7492
7493 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7494 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7495 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7496
7497 @itemize @bullet
7498 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7499 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7500 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7501 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7502 @end itemize
7503 @end deffn
7504
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7508 @cindex str9xpec
7509
7510 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7511 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7512 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7513 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7514
7515 Here is some background info to help
7516 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7517 the str9:
7518 @enumerate
7519 @item
7520 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7521 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7522 @item
7523 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7524 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7525 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7526 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7527 @end enumerate
7528
7529 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7530 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7531 configured for flash bank 0.
7532 @example
7533 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7534 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7535 adapter assert srst
7536 # turn off target polling
7537 poll off
7538 # disable str9 core
7539 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7540 # read option bytes
7541 str9xpec options_read 0
7542 # re-enable str9 core
7543 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7544 poll on
7545 reset halt
7546 @end example
7547 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7548 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7549 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7550 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7551
7552 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7553
7554 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7555 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7556 @end deffn
7557
7558 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7559 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7560 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7561 @end deffn
7562
7563 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7564 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7565 erase the device.
7566 @end deffn
7567
7568 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7569 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7570 @end deffn
7571
7572 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7573 Configure str9 boot bank.
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7577 Configure str9 lvd source.
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7581 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7585 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7589 Read str9 option bytes.
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7593 Write str9 option bytes.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7597 unlock str9 device.
7598 @end deffn
7599
7600 @end deffn
7601
7602 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7603 @cindex swm050
7604 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7605
7606 @example
7607 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7608 @end example
7609
7610 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7611
7612 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7613 Erases the entire flash bank.
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 @end deffn
7617
7618
7619 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7620 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7621 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7622 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7623
7624 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7625
7626 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7627 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7628 @end deffn
7629
7630 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7631 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7632 @end deffn
7633
7634 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7635 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7636 the flash clock.
7637 @end deffn
7638 @end deffn
7639
7640 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7641 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7642 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7643 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7644 correct bank config.
7645
7646 @example
7647 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7648 @end example
7649 @end deffn
7650
7651 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7652 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7653 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7657 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7658 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7659
7660 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7661
7662 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7663 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7664 @end deffn
7665
7666 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7667 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7668 @end deffn
7669
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @section NAND Flash Commands
7673 @cindex NAND
7674
7675 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7676 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7677 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7678
7679 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7680 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7681 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7682 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7683 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7684 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7685
7686 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7687 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7688 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7689 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7690 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7691 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7692 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7693 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7694 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7695 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7696
7697 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7698 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7699 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7700 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7701 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7702 every 512 bytes of data.
7703
7704 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7705 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7706 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7707 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7708 ECC mode is used.
7709
7710 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7711 @enumerate
7712 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7713 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7714 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7715 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7716 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7717 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7718 to access that device.
7719 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7720 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7721 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7722 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7723 de-brick a board.
7724 @end enumerate
7725
7726 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7727 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7728 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7729 are only 32 bits wide.
7730 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7731 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7732 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7733 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7734
7735 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7736 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7737 @cindex NAND configuration
7738
7739 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7740 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7741 OpenOCD has initialized.
7742
7743 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7744 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7745 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7746 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7747 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7748 they were a single (larger) device.
7749 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7750 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7751
7752 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7753 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7754 configuration files, not interactively.
7755
7756 @itemize @bullet
7757 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7758 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7759 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7760 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7761 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7762 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7763 commands to the NAND controller.
7764 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7765 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7766 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7767 for more information.
7768 @end itemize
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7772 Prints a summary of each device declared
7773 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7774 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7775 @example
7776 > nand list
7777 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7778 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7779 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7780 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7781 >
7782 @end example
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7786 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7787 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7788 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7789 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7790 it with most other NAND commands.
7791 @end deffn
7792
7793 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7794
7795 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7796 @cindex NAND reading
7797 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7798 starting at the specified offset.
7799 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7800
7801 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7802 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7803
7804 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7805 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7806 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7807
7808 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7809 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7810 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7811 method which handled that error correction.
7812
7813 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7814 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7815 @itemize @bullet
7816 @item no oob_* parameter
7817 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7818 @item @code{oob_raw}
7819 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7820 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7821 spare areas associated with each data page.
7822 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7823 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7824 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7825 @item @code{oob_only}
7826 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7827 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7828 spare areas associated with each data page.
7829 @end itemize
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7833 @cindex NAND erasing
7834 @cindex NAND programming
7835 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7836 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7837 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7838 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7839 If those parameters are not specified,
7840 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7841 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7842
7843 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7844 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7845 block marker.
7846 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7847 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7851 @cindex NAND writing
7852 @cindex NAND programming
7853 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7854 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7855 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7856 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7857
7858 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7859 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7860
7861 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7862 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7863 past the end of the device.
7864 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7865 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7866 if that's being written.)
7867
7868 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7869 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7870 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7871
7872 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7873 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7874 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7875 @itemize @bullet
7876 @item no oob_* parameter
7877 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7878 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7879 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7880 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7881 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7882 @item @code{oob_only}
7883 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7884 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7885 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7886 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7887 @item @code{oob_raw}
7888 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7889 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7890 un-altered OOB.
7891 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7892 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7893 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7894 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7895 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7896 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7897 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7898 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7899 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7900 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7901 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7902 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7903 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7904 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7905 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7906 @end itemize
7907 @end deffn
7908
7909 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7910 @cindex NAND verification
7911 @cindex NAND programming
7912 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7913 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7914 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7915
7916 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7917 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7918
7919 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7920 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7921 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7922 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7923 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7924
7925 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7926 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7927 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7928
7929 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7930 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7931 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7932 be removed in a future release.
7933 @end deffn
7934
7935 @subsection Other NAND commands
7936 @cindex NAND other commands
7937
7938 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7939 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7940 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7941 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7942 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7943 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7944 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7945 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7946
7947 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7948 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7949 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7953 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7954 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7955 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7956 status for each block.
7957 @end deffn
7958
7959 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7960 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7961 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7962
7963 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7964 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7965 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7966 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7967 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7968
7969 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7970 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7971 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7972 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7973 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7974 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7975 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7979 @subsection NAND Driver List
7980 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7981 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7982 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7983
7984 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7985 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7986 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7987 address of the ECC controller.
7988 @example
7989 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7990 @end example
7991 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7992 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7993 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7994 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7995 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7996 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7997 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7998 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7999 @end deffn
8000 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8001 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8002 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8006 properly configured for input or output.
8007 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8008 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8009 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8010 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8011 @end deffn
8012 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8013 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8014 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8015 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8016 @end deffn
8017 @end deffn
8018
8019 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8020 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8021 chips from Texas Instruments.
8022 It takes three extra parameters:
8023 address of the NAND chip;
8024 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8025 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8026 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8027 @example
8028 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8029 @end example
8030 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8031 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8032 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8033 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8034 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8038 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8039 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8040 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8041 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8042 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8043 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8044 @end deffn
8045
8046 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8047 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8048 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8049 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8050 @end deffn
8051 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8052
8053 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8054 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8055 should work for this chip as well.
8056 @end deffn
8057
8058 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8059 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8060 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8061 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8062 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8063 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8064 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8065 @example
8066 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8067 @end example
8068 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8069 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8070 without parameter query status.
8071 @end deffn
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8075 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8076 parameter: the address of the controller.
8077 @example
8078 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8079 @end example
8080 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8081 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8082 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8083 change any behavior.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8087 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8088 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8089 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8090 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8091 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8092 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8093 specialized commands.
8094 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8095 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8096 change any behavior.
8097 @end deffn
8098
8099 @node Flash Programming
8100 @chapter Flash Programming
8101
8102 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8103 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8104 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8105
8106 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8107 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8108
8109 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8110 @enumerate
8111 @item 'init' is executed.
8112 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8113 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8114 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8115 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8116 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8117 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8118 @end enumerate
8119
8120 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8121
8122 @example
8123 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8124 # are optional parameters
8125 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8126 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8127
8128 # binary files need the flash address passing
8129 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8130 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8131 @end example
8132
8133 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8134 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8135 @cindex PLD
8136 @cindex FPGA
8137
8138 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8139 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8140 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8141 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8142 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8143 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8144 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8145
8146 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8147
8148 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8149 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8150 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8151
8152 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8153 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8154
8155 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8156 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8157 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8158 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8159 behavior.
8160 @end deffn
8161
8162 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8163 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8167 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8168 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8169 @end deffn
8170
8171 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8172
8173 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8174 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8175 that particular type of PLD.
8176
8177 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8178 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8179 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8180
8181 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8182 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8183 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8184
8185 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8186 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8187 for FPGA @var{num}.
8188 @end deffn
8189 @end deffn
8190
8191 @node General Commands
8192 @chapter General Commands
8193 @cindex commands
8194
8195 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8196 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8197 commands are documented elsewhere.
8198
8199 Intent:
8200 @itemize @bullet
8201 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8202 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8203 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8204 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8205
8206 @item @b{From the human}
8207 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8208 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8209
8210 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8211 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8212 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8213
8214 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8215 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8216 port is 5555.
8217 @end itemize
8218
8219
8220 @section Server Commands
8221
8222 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8223 Exits the current telnet session.
8224 @end deffn
8225
8226 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8227 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8228 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8229 Not every command provides helptext.
8230
8231 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8232 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8233 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8234 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8235 @end deffn
8236
8237 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8238 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8239 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8240 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8241 Useful in connection with script files
8242 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8243 @end deffn
8244
8245 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8246 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8247 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8248 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8249
8250 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8251 @example
8252 # redefine shutdown
8253 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8254 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8255 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8256 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8257 original_shutdown
8258 @}
8259 @end example
8260 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8261 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8262 @end deffn
8263
8264 @anchor{debuglevel}
8265 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8266 @cindex message level
8267 Display debug level.
8268 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8269 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8270 Level 0 is error messages only;
8271 level 1 adds warnings;
8272 level 2 adds informational messages;
8273 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8274 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8275 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8276 the command line along with the location of that log
8277 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8278 @xref{Running}.
8279 @end deffn
8280
8281 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8282 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8283 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8284 @example
8285 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8286 @end example
8287 @end deffn
8288
8289 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8290 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8291 the default log output channel is stderr.
8292 @end deffn
8293
8294 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8295 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8296 @end deffn
8297
8298 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8299 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8300 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8301 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8302 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8306 @section Target State handling
8307 @cindex reset
8308 @cindex halt
8309 @cindex target initialization
8310
8311 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8312 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8313 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8314 a current target which is used to perform the
8315 various operations. The current target may be changed
8316 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8317 target which should become current.
8318
8319 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8320 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8321 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8322 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8323 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8324
8325 @emph{With no arguments}:
8326 list all available registers for the current target,
8327 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8328 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8329 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8330 are flagged as such.
8331
8332 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8333 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8334 bypassing any internal cache.
8335
8336 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8337 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8338 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8339 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8340 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8341 relevant module will flush such values.
8342
8343 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8344 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8345
8346 @example
8347 > reg
8348 ===== ARM registers
8349 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8350 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8351 (2) r2 (/32)
8352 ...
8353 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8354 >
8355 @end example
8356 @end deffn
8357
8358 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8359 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8360 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8361 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8362 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8363 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8364 (and enter debug mode).
8365 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8366
8367 @quotation Warning
8368 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8369 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8370 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8371 power mode by gating the core clock;
8372 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8373
8374 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8375 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8376 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8377 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8378 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8379 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8380
8381 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8382 work with a JTAG debugger.
8383 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8384 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8385 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8386 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8387 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8388 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8389 @end quotation
8390
8391 @end deffn
8392
8393 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8394 Resume the target at its current code position,
8395 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8396 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8397 @end deffn
8398
8399 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8400 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8401 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8402 @end deffn
8403
8404 @anchor{resetcommand}
8405 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8406 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8407 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8408 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8409 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8410 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8411 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8412
8413 The optional parameter specifies what should
8414 happen after the reset.
8415 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8416 The other options will not work on all systems.
8417 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8418
8419 @itemize @minus
8420 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8421 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8422 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8423 @end itemize
8424 @end deffn
8425
8426 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8427 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8428 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8429 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8430 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8431 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8432 state.
8433 @end deffn
8434
8435 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8436 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8437 Set values of reset signals.
8438 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8439 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8440 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8441 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8442
8443 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8444 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8445 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8446 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8447 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8448 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8449 the signal will not be modified.
8450
8451 @quotation Note
8452 TRST is specially handled.
8453 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8454 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8455 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8456 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8457 instead of the TRST signal.
8458 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8459 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8460 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8461 with handlers for that event.
8462 @end quotation
8463 @end deffn
8464
8465 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8466 @section Memory access commands
8467 @cindex memory access
8468
8469 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8470 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8471 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8472 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8473
8474 @enumerate
8475 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8476 to change the current target.
8477 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8478 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8479 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8480 @end enumerate
8481
8482 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8483 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8484 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8485 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8486 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8487 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8488 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8489 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8490 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8491 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8492 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8493 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8494 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8495 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8496 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8497 @end deffn
8498
8499 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8500 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8501 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8502 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8503 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8504 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8505 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8506 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8507 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8508 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8509 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8510 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8511 @end deffn
8512
8513 @anchor{imageaccess}
8514 @section Image loading commands
8515 @cindex image loading
8516 @cindex image dumping
8517
8518 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8519 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8520 binary file named @var{filename}.
8521 @end deffn
8522
8523 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8524 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8525 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8529 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8530 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8531 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8532 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8533 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8534 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8535 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8536 separately.
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8540 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8541 The file format may optionally be specified
8542 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8543 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8544 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8545 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8546 @example
8547 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8548 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8549 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8550 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8551 $address $length
8552 @}
8553 @end example
8554 @end deffn
8555
8556 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8557 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8558 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8559 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8560 The file format may optionally be specified
8561 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8562 @end deffn
8563
8564 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8565 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8566 The file format may optionally be specified
8567 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8568 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8569 @end deffn
8570
8571 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8572 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8573 The file format may optionally be specified
8574 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8575 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8576 @end deffn
8577
8578
8579 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8580 @cindex breakpoint
8581 @cindex watchpoint
8582
8583 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8584 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8585 watchpoints.
8586 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8587
8588 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8589 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8590 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8591 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8592 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8593 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8594
8595 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8596 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8600 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8601 @end deffn
8602
8603 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8604 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8605 @end deffn
8606
8607 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8608 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8609 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8610 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8611 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8612 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8613 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8614 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8615 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8616 @end deffn
8617
8618
8619 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8620
8621 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8622 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8623 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8624 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8625 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8626 running, can be used.
8627 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8628 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8629 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8630
8631 @quotation Note
8632 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8633 @end quotation
8634
8635 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8636 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8637 communication, respectively.
8638
8639 @quotation Note
8640 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8641 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8642 example.
8643 @end quotation
8644
8645 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8646 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8647 of TCP/IP connections.
8648
8649 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8650 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8651 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8652 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8653 @var{size} bytes.
8654 @end deffn
8655
8656 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8657 Start RTT.
8658 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8662 Stop RTT.
8663 @end deffn
8664
8665 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8666 Display the polling interval.
8667 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8668 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8669 checked for new data.
8670 @end deffn
8671
8672 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8673 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8674 @end deffn
8675
8676 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8677 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8678 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8679 @end deffn
8680
8681 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8682 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8683 @end deffn
8684
8685 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8686 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8687 @end deffn
8688
8689 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8690 on the target device.
8691
8692 @example
8693 resume
8694
8695 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8696 rtt start
8697
8698 rtt server start 9090 0
8699 @end example
8700
8701 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8702 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8703 TCP/IP port 9090.
8704
8705
8706 @section Misc Commands
8707
8708 @cindex profiling
8709 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8710 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8711 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8712 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8713 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8714 limit the address range.
8715 @end deffn
8716
8717 @deffn {Command} {version}
8718 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8719 @end deffn
8720
8721 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8722 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8723 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8724 @end deffn
8725
8726 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8727 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8728 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8729 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8730
8731 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8732 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8733 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8734 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8735
8736 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8737 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8738 @cindex tracing
8739 @cindex ETM
8740 @cindex ETB
8741
8742 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8743 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8744 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8745
8746 @itemize
8747 @item
8748 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8749 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8750 supports such an interface.
8751 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8752 and trace port support.)
8753 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8754 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8755 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8756 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8757 in the board-specific configuration file.
8758 @item
8759 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8760 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8761 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8762 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8763 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8764 @end itemize
8765
8766 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8767
8768 @quotation Issues
8769 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8770 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8771
8772 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8773 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8774 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8775 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8776 dummy trace port driver}.
8777
8778 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8779 as well as tracing only during specific states
8780 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8781
8782 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8783 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8784 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8785 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8786 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8787
8788 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8789 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8790 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8791 this original style of JTAG access.
8792 @end quotation
8793
8794 @subsection ETM Configuration
8795 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8796
8797 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8798 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8799 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8800
8801 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8802 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8803 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8804 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8805 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8806 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8807 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8808 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8809 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8810
8811 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8812 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8813 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8814
8815 @quotation Warning
8816 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8817 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8818 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8819 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8820 @end quotation
8821
8822 @quotation Note
8823 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8824 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8825 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8826 what CPU activities are traced.
8827 @end quotation
8828 @end deffn
8829
8830 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8831 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8832 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8833 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8834 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8835 @end deffn
8836
8837 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8838 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8839 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8840 Did trace data overflow?
8841 Was it triggered?
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8845 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8846 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8847 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8848 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8849
8850 @itemize
8851 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8852 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8853 The value is one of
8854 @option{none} (save nothing),
8855 @option{data} (save data),
8856 @option{address} (save addresses),
8857 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8858 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8859 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8860 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8861 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8862 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8863 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8864 trace stream without an image of the code.
8865 @end itemize
8866 @end deffn
8867
8868 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8869 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8870 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8871 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8872 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8873
8874 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8875 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8876 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8877 @end deffn
8878
8879 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8880
8881 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8882 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8883 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8884
8885 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8886 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8887 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8888 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8889 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8890 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8891 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8892
8893 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8894
8895 @itemize
8896 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8897 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8898 for instruction access within that function's body.
8899 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8900 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8901 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8902 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8903 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8904 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8905 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8906 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8907 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8908 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8909 @item @emph{... more}
8910 @end itemize
8911
8912 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8913 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8914
8915 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8916 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8917 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8918 @end deffn
8919
8920 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8921 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8922 @end deffn
8923
8924 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8925 Opens an image file.
8926 @end deffn
8927
8928 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8929 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8930 @end deffn
8931
8932 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8933 Starts trace data collection.
8934 @end deffn
8935
8936 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8937 Stops trace data collection.
8938 @end deffn
8939
8940 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8941 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8942
8943 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8944
8945 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8946 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8947 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8948 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8949 any trace data collection.}
8950 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8951 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8952 @end deffn
8953 @end deffn
8954
8955 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8956 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8957 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8958 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8959 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8960 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8961 @end deffn
8962 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8963 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8964 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8965 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8966 trace trigger becomes active.
8967
8968 @itemize
8969 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8970 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8971 afterwards.
8972 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8973 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8974 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8975 what caused that event to happen.
8976 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8977 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8978 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8979 how the event caused trouble.
8980 @end itemize
8981 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8982 @end deffn
8983
8984 @end deffn
8985
8986 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8987 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8988 @cindex CTI
8989
8990 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8991 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8992 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8993 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8994 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8995 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8996
8997 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8998 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8999 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9000 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9001 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9002 including additional configuration.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9006 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9007 @end deffn
9008
9009 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9010 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9014 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9018 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9019 @end deffn
9020
9021 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9022 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9023 @end deffn
9024
9025 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9026 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9027 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9028 @end deffn
9029
9030 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9031 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9032 of the CTI.
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9036 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9037 useful in TCL scripting.
9038 @end deffn
9039
9040 @section Generic ARM
9041 @cindex ARM
9042
9043 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9044 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9045 commands that may be available.
9046
9047 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9048 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9049 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9050 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9051 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9052 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9053 @end deffn
9054
9055 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9056 @cindex disassemble
9057 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9058 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9059 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9060 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9061 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9062 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9063 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9064
9065 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9066 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9067 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9068 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9069 with a handful of exceptions.
9070 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9071 @end deffn
9072
9073 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9074 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9075 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9076 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9077 and using the MCR instruction.
9078 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9079 an ARM register.)
9080 @end deffn
9081
9082 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9083 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9084 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9085 and the MRC instruction.
9086 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9087 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9088 an ARM register.)
9089 @end deffn
9090
9091 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9092 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9093 core mode if necessary.
9094 @end deffn
9095
9096 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9097 @cindex ARM semihosting
9098 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9099
9100 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9101 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9102 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9103 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9104 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9105 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9106 @end deffn
9107
9108 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9109 @cindex ARM semihosting
9110 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9111
9112 @example
9113 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9114 @end example
9115
9116 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9117 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9118 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9119 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9123 @cindex ARM semihosting
9124 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9125 status.
9126
9127 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9128 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9129 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9130 debugger.
9131 @end deffn
9132
9133 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9134 @cindex ARM semihosting
9135 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9136
9137 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9138 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9139 the value returned by the target.
9140
9141 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9142 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9143 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9144 encountering a break.
9145
9146 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9147 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9148 to the debugger.
9149 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9150 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9151 request or equivalent").
9152
9153 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9154 this option (default: disabled).
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9158 @cindex ARMv4
9159 @cindex ARMv5
9160
9161 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9162 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9163 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9164 variant.
9165
9166 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9167 @cindex ARM7
9168 @cindex ARM9
9169
9170 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9171 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9172 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9173 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9174
9175 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9176 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9177 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9178 instead of breakpoints.
9179 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9180
9181 This should be
9182 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9183 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9184 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9185 @end deffn
9186
9187 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9188 @cindex DCC
9189 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9190 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9191 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9192
9193 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9194 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9195 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9196 @end deffn
9197
9198 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9199 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9200 that don't check completion of the operation.
9201 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9202
9203 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9204 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9205 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9206 @end deffn
9207
9208 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9209 @cindex ARM9
9210
9211 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9212 integer processors.
9213 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9214
9215 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9216 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9217 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9218 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9219
9220 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9221 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9222 @cindex vector_catch
9223 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9224 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9225 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9226 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9227 to those hardware vectors.
9228
9229 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9230 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9231 vector catch hardware to intercept
9232 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9233 @option{none} of them,
9234 or a list with one or more of the following:
9235 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9236 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9237 @end deffn
9238
9239 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9240 @cindex ARM920T
9241
9242 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9243 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9244 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9245 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9246 and ARM9 commands.
9247
9248 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9249 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9250 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9251 @end deffn
9252
9253 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9254 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9255 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9256 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9257 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9258 (Not all registers can be written.)
9259 @end deffn
9260
9261 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9262 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9263 @end deffn
9264
9265 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9266 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9267 @end deffn
9268
9269 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9270 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9271
9272 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9273 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9274 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9275 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9276 and ARM9 commands.
9277
9278 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9279 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9280
9281 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9282 Print information about the caches found.
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9286 @cindex ARM966E
9287
9288 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9289 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9290 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9291 and ARM9 commands.
9292
9293 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9294 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9295 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9296 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9297 ARM966E-S TRM.
9298 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9299 as required for BIST support.
9300 @end deffn
9301
9302 @subsection XScale specific commands
9303 @cindex XScale
9304
9305 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9306
9307 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9308 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9309 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9310 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9311 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9312 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9313 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9314
9315 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9316 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9317 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9318 the mini-IC.
9319
9320 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9321 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9322 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9323 code layout in memory:
9324 @example
9325 _vectors:
9326 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9327 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9328 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9329 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9330 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9331 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9332 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9333 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9334 .org 0x100
9335 .long real_reset_vector
9336 .long real_ui_handler
9337 .long real_swi_handler
9338 .long real_pf_abort
9339 .long real_data_abort
9340 .long 0 /* unused */
9341 .long real_irq_handler
9342 .long real_fiq_handler
9343 @end example
9344
9345 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9346 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9347 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9348 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9349 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9350 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9351 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9352 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9353 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9354 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9355 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9356 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9357 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9358 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9359 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9360 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9361 software.
9362
9363 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9364 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9365 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9366 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9367
9368 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9369 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9370 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9371 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9372 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9373 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9374 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9375 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9376 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9377
9378 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9379 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9380
9381 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9382 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9383 @end deffn
9384
9385 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9386 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9387 @end deffn
9388
9389 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9390 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9391 @end deffn
9392
9393 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9394 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9395 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9396 @end deffn
9397
9398 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9399 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9400 @end deffn
9401
9402 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9403 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9407 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9411 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9412 @end deffn
9413
9414 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9415 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9416 @end deffn
9417
9418 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9419 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9420 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9421 and modifying how it is emptied.
9422 @end deffn
9423
9424 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9425 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9426 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9427 The image @var{type} may be one of
9428 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9429 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9430 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9431 @end deffn
9432
9433 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9434 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9435 @cindex vector_catch
9436 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9437 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9438
9439 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9440 @example
9441 0x01 Trap Reset
9442 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9443 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9444 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9445 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9446 0x20 reserved
9447 0x40 Trap IRQ
9448 0x80 Trap FIQ
9449 @end example
9450 @end deffn
9451
9452 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9453 @cindex vector_table
9454
9455 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9456 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9457 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9458 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9459 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9460
9461 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9462
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9466 @cindex ARMv6
9467
9468 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9469 @cindex ARM11
9470
9471 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9472 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9473 which is enabled by default.
9474 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9475 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9476 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9477 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9478 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9479 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9480 @end deffn
9481
9482 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9483 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9484 which is enabled by default.
9485 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9486 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9487 @end deffn
9488
9489 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9490 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9491 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9492 they are disabled by default.
9493 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9494 @end deffn
9495
9496 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9497 @cindex vector_catch
9498 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9499 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9500 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9501
9502 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9503 for certain hardware events.
9504 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9505 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9506 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9507 @end deffn
9508
9509 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9510 @cindex ARMv7
9511 @cindex ARMv8
9512
9513 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9514 @cindex Cortex-A
9515
9516 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9517 display information about target caches
9518 @end deffn
9519
9520 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9521 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9522 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9523 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9524 Defaults to 'off'.
9525 @end deffn
9526
9527 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9528 Initialize core debug
9529 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9530 @end deffn
9531
9532 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9533 Display/set the current SMP mode
9534 @end deffn
9535
9536 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9537 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9538 @end deffn
9539
9540 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9541 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9545 configure l2x cache
9546 @end deffn
9547
9548 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9549 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9550 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9551 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9552 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9553 @end deffn
9554
9555 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9556 @cindex Cortex-R
9557
9558 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9559 Initialize core debug
9560 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9561 @end deffn
9562
9563 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9564 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9565 @end deffn
9566
9567
9568 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9569 @cindex tracing
9570 @cindex SWO
9571 @cindex SWV
9572 @cindex TPIU
9573
9574 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9575 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9576 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9577 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9578
9579 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9580 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9581 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9582 which causes quite some confusion.
9583 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9584 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9585
9586 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9587 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9588 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9589
9590 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9591 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9592 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9593 @end deffn
9594
9595 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9596 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9597 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9598 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9599
9600 @itemize @bullet
9601 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9602 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9603 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9604 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9605
9606 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9607 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9608 @end itemize
9609 @end deffn
9610
9611 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9612 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9613 @end deffn
9614
9615 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9616 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9617 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9618 at any time after the initialization, too.
9619 @end deffn
9620
9621 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9622 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9623 individually queried, to return its current value.
9624 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9625 @end deffn
9626
9627 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9628 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9629 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9630 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9631
9632 @itemize @bullet
9633 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9634 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9635
9636 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9637 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9638
9639 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9640 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9641
9642 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9643 protocol used for trace data:
9644 @itemize @minus
9645 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9646 data bits (default);
9647 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9648 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9649 @end itemize
9650
9651 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9652 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9653 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9654 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9655 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9656 of the TPIU.
9657
9658 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9659 the destination of the trace data:
9660 @itemize @minus
9661 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9662 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9663 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9664 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9665 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9666 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9667 each connected client;
9668 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9669 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9670 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9671 @end itemize
9672
9673 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9674 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9675 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9676 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9677
9678 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9679 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9680 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9681 maximum supported rate automatically.
9682
9683 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9684 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9685 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9686
9687 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9688 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9689 default value is @var{0}.
9690 @end itemize
9691 @end deffn
9692
9693 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9694 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9695 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9696 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9697 data.
9698 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9699 after the @command{init}.
9700 @end deffn
9701
9702 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9703 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9704 @end deffn
9705
9706
9707
9708 Example usage:
9709 @enumerate
9710 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9711 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9712 enough to:
9713 @example
9714 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9715 ...
9716 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9717 ...
9718 @end example
9719 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9720 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9721 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9722 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9723 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9724 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9725 @example
9726 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9727 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9728 @end example
9729 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9730 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9731 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9732 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9733 @example
9734 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9735 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9736 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9737 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9738 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9739 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9740 @end example
9741 @end enumerate
9742
9743 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9744 @cindex tracing
9745 @cindex SWO
9746 @cindex SWV
9747 @cindex ITM
9748 @cindex ETM
9749
9750 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9751 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9752 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9753 @end deffn
9754
9755 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9756 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9757 @end deffn
9758
9759 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9760 @cindex Cortex-M
9761
9762 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9763 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9764
9765 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9766 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9767 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9768 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9769 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9770 the step command leaves with the core running.
9771
9772 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9773 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9774 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9775 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9776
9777 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9778 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9779 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9780 does.
9781
9782 Default is @option{auto}.
9783 @end deffn
9784
9785 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9786 @cindex vector_catch
9787 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9788 for certain hardware events.
9789
9790 Parameters request interception of
9791 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9792 @option{none} of them,
9793 or one or more of the following:
9794 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9795 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9796 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9797 @option{irq_err},
9798 @option{state_err},
9799 @option{chk_err}, or
9800 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9801 @option{reset}.
9802 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9803 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9804 are mapped to HardFault.
9805 UsageFault checks for
9806 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9807 must also be explicitly enabled.
9808
9809 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9810 @end deffn
9811
9812 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9813 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9814 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9815
9816 @itemize @minus
9817 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9818 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9819 @end itemize
9820
9821 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9822 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9823 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9824 to manually reset the peripherals.
9825 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9826
9827 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9828 instead.
9829 @end deffn
9830
9831 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9832 @cindex ARMv8-A
9833 @cindex aarch64
9834
9835 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9836 Display information about target caches
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9840 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9841 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9842 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9843 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9844 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9845 @end deffn
9846
9847 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9848 @cindex disassemble
9849 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9850 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9854 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9855 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9856 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9857 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9858 @end deffn
9859
9860 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9861 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9862 @option{on}.
9863 @end deffn
9864
9865 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9866 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9867 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9868 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9869 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9870 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9871 @end deffn
9872
9873 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9874
9875 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9876 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9877
9878 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9879
9880 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9881 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9882 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9883 @end deffn
9884
9885 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9886 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9887 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9888 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9889 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9890 @end deffn
9891
9892 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9893
9894 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9895 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9896 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9897 @end deffn
9898
9899 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9900
9901 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9902 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9903 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9904 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9905 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9906 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9907 can be collected.
9908
9909 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9910 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9911 tooling.
9912
9913 @quotation Issues
9914 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9915 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9916 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9917 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9918
9919 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9920 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9921 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9922 software operation on the CPU.
9923 @end quotation
9924
9925 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9926 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9927 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9928 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9929 @end deffn
9930
9931 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9932 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9933 @end deffn
9934
9935 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9936 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9937 control is disabled.
9938 @end deffn
9939
9940 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9941 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9942 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9943 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9944
9945 Supported trace formats:
9946 @itemize
9947 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9948 timing to be determined.
9949 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9950 addresses.
9951 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9952 @end itemize
9953 @end deffn
9954
9955 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9956 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9957 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9958 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9959
9960 Supported conditions:
9961 @itemize
9962 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9963 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9964 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9965 instruction matches start data and mask.
9966 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9967 instruction matches start data and mask.
9968 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9969 data and mask.
9970 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9971 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9972 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9973 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9974 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9975 @end itemize
9976 @end deffn
9977
9978 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9979 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9980 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9981 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9982
9983 Supported conditions:
9984 @itemize
9985 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9986 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9987 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9988 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9989 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9990 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9991 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9992 data and mask.
9993 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9994 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9995 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9996 @end itemize
9997 @end deffn
9998
9999 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10000 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10001
10002 Supported triggers:
10003 @itemize
10004 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10005 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10006 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10007 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10008 collection.
10009 @end itemize
10010 @end deffn
10011
10012 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10013
10014 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10015 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10016 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10017 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10021 Display trace configuration.
10022 @end deffn
10023
10024 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10025 Display trace collection status.
10026 @end deffn
10027
10028 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10029 Start manual trace collection.
10030 @end deffn
10031
10032 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10033 Stop manual trace collection.
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10037 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10038 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10039 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10040 @option{size} options using DMA.
10041 @end deffn
10042
10043 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10044 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10045 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10046 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10047 @option{size} options using DMA.
10048 @end deffn
10049
10050 @section Intel Architecture
10051
10052 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10053 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10054 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10055 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10056 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10057 @itemize
10058 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10059 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10060 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10061 @end itemize
10062
10063 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10064 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10065 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10066
10067 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10068 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10072 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10073 @end deffn
10074
10075 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10076 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10077 @end deffn
10078
10079 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10080 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10081 @end deffn
10082
10083 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10084 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10085 @end deffn
10086
10087 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10088 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10089 @end deffn
10090
10091 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10092
10093 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10094 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10095
10096 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10097 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10098 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10099 @end deffn
10100 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10101 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10102
10103 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10104
10105 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10106 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10107 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10108 @end deffn
10109
10110 @subsection Registers commands
10111 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10112 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10113 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10114
10115 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10116
10117 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10118 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10119 and "timer" groups.
10120
10121 @emph{example:}
10122 @example
10123 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10124 @end example
10125
10126 @end deffn
10127
10128 @section RISC-V Architecture
10129
10130 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10131 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10132 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10133 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10134 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10135 implement version 0.11.
10136
10137 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10138
10139 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10140 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10141 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10142
10143 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10144
10145 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10146 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10147 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10148
10149 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10150 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10151 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10152 CSRs.
10153 @end deffn
10154
10155 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10156 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10157 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10158 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10159 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10160 This command must be executed before `init`.
10161 @end deffn
10162
10163 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10164 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10165 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10166 @end deffn
10167
10168 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10169 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10170 deasserted.
10171 @end deffn
10172
10173 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10174 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10175 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10176 @end deffn
10177
10178 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10179 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10180 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10181 on physical memory.
10182 @end deffn
10183
10184 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10185 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10186 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10187 performed on physical memory.
10188 @end deffn
10189
10190 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10191 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10192 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10193 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10194 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10195 race condition problem in your code.
10196
10197 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10198 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10199 @end deffn
10200
10201 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10202 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10203 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10204 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10205 values.
10206
10207 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10208 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10209 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10210 @end deffn
10211
10212 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10213 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10214 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10218 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10219 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10220 @end deffn
10221
10222 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10223 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10224 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10225 @end deffn
10226
10227 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10228 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10229 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10230 @end deffn
10231
10232 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10233
10234 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10235 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10236 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10237 @example
10238 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10239 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10240 @end example
10241
10242 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10243 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10247 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10248 @end deffn
10249
10250 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10251
10252 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10253 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10254
10255 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10256 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10257 @end deffn
10258
10259 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10260 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10261 @end deffn
10262
10263 @section ARC Architecture
10264 @cindex ARC
10265
10266 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10267 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10268 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10269 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10270 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10271 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10272 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10273 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10274 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10275 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10276 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10277 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10278 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10279 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10280 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10281
10282
10283 @subsection General ARC commands
10284
10285 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10286
10287 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10288 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10289 arguments:
10290
10291 @itemize @bullet
10292
10293 @item @code{-name} name
10294 @*Name of a register.
10295
10296 @item @code{-num} number
10297 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10298
10299 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10300 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10301
10302 @end itemize
10303
10304 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10305
10306 @itemize @bullet
10307
10308 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10309 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10310 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10311 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10312 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10313 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10314
10315 @item @code{-core}
10316 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10317 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10318 spaces.
10319
10320 @item @code{-bcr}
10321 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10322 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10323 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10324 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10325 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10326
10327 @item @code{-type} type_name
10328 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10329 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10330
10331 @item @code{-g}
10332 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10333 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10334 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10335 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10336 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10337
10338 @end itemize
10339
10340 @end deffn
10341
10342 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10343 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10344 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10345 @end deffn
10346
10347 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10348 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10349 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10350 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10351 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10352 startbit endbit}.
10353 @end deffn
10354
10355 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10356 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10357 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10358 @end deffn
10359
10360 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10361 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10362 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10363 @end deffn
10364
10365 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10366
10367 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10368 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10369 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10370 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10371
10372 @end deffn
10373
10374 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10375 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10376 registers.
10377 @end deffn
10378
10379 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10380 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10381 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10382 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10383
10384 @end deffn
10385
10386 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10387 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10388 registers.
10389 @end deffn
10390
10391 @section STM8 Architecture
10392 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10393 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10394
10395 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10396 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10397
10398 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10399 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10400 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10401 @cindex tracing
10402 @cindex libdcc
10403 @cindex DCC
10404 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10405 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10406 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10407 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10408
10409 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10410 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10411 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10412 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10413 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10414 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10415
10416 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10417 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10418 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10419 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10420 The target being debugged may
10421 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10422 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10423 each supported by a command:
10424
10425 @itemize
10426 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10427 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10428 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10429 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10430
10431 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10432 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10433 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10434
10435 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10436 and then displayed at any time.
10437 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10438
10439 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10440 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10441 @end itemize
10442
10443 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10444 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10445 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10446 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10447 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10448 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10449 does the same thing.
10450
10451 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10452 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10453 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10454 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10455 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10456
10457 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10458 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10459 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10460 @end deffn
10461
10462 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10463 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10464 in the order they triggered.
10465 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10466 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10467 history records.
10468 @end deffn
10469
10470 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10471 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10472 they have been triggered.
10473 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10474 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10475 and associates it with that identifier.
10476
10477 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10478 are not related except by this command.
10479 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10480 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10481 @end deffn
10482
10483
10484 @node JTAG Commands
10485 @chapter JTAG Commands
10486 @cindex JTAG Commands
10487 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10488 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10489 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10490 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10491 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10492
10493 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10494 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10495
10496 @itemize @bullet
10497 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10498 devices such as a CPUs.
10499 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10500 standard state machine (in parallel)
10501 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10502 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10503 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10504 while the reading previous ones.
10505 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10506 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10507 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10508 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10509 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10510 registers.
10511 @end itemize
10512
10513 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10514
10515 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10516 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10517 the order of TAP state transitions.
10518 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10519 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10520 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10521 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10522 these commands are not available.
10523
10524 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10525 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10526 that specify the entire register.
10527 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10528 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10529 The return value holds the original value of each
10530 of those fields.
10531
10532 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10533 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10534 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10535 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10536 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10537
10538 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10539 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10540
10541 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10542 in that state.
10543 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10544 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10545 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10546
10547 @quotation Warning
10548 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10549 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10550 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10551 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10552 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10553 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10554 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10555 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10556 @end quotation
10557 @end deffn
10558
10559 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10560 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10561 This may be used for performance tuning.
10562
10563 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10564 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10565 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10566 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10567 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10568 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10569 @end deffn
10570
10571 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10572 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10573 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10574 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10575 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10576 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10577
10578 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10579 in that state.
10580 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10581 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10582 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10583
10584 @quotation Note
10585 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10586 register values, unlike data register values.
10587 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10588 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10589 @end quotation
10590 @end deffn
10591
10592 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10593 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10594 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10595 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10596 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10597 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10598 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10599 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10600 The final state must also be stable.
10601 @end deffn
10602
10603 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10604 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10605 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10606 Instructions often need some time
10607 to execute before they take effect.
10608 @end deffn
10609
10610 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10611 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10612
10613 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10614 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10615 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10616 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10617 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10618 @end deffn
10619
10620 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10621 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10622 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10623 must also be enabled.
10624 Default is enabled.
10625 @end deffn
10626
10627 @section TAP state names
10628 @cindex TAP state names
10629
10630 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10631 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10632 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10633 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10634
10635 @itemize @bullet
10636 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10637 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10638 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10639 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10640 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10641 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10642 through the data register
10643 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10644 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10645 for update or more shifting
10646 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10647 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10648 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10649 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10650 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10651 through the instruction register
10652 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10653 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10654 for update or more shifting
10655 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10656 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10657 @end itemize
10658
10659 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10660 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10661 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10662 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10663
10664 @itemize @bullet
10665 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10666 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10667 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10668 may not be as expected.
10669 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10670 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10671 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10672 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10673 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10674 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10675 @end itemize
10676
10677 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10678 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10679
10680 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10681 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10682 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10683 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10684
10685 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10686 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10687 @cindex SVF
10688
10689 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10690 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10691 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10692 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10693
10694 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10695 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10696 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10697 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10698
10699 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10700 affect their semantics.
10701
10702 Command options:
10703 @itemize @minus
10704 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10705 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10706 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10707 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10708 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10709 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10710 on the real interface;
10711 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10712 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10713 errors.
10714 @end itemize
10715 @end deffn
10716
10717 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10718 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10719 @cindex XSVF
10720
10721 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10722 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10723 Xilinx devices.
10724 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10725 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10726
10727 @quotation Important
10728 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10729 @end quotation
10730
10731 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10732 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10733 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10734 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10735 that TAP.
10736 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10737 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10738 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10739 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10740 @end deffn
10741
10742 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10743 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10744 after building the software.
10745 You may find them useful:
10746
10747 @itemize
10748 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10749 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10750 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10751 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10752 @end itemize
10753
10754 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10755 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10756 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10757 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10758 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10759 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10760 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10761
10762
10763 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10764 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10765 @cindex IPDBG
10766
10767 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10768 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10769 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10770 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10771 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10772 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10773
10774 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10775 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10776
10777 Command options:
10778 @itemize @bullet
10779 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10780 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10781 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10782 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10783 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10784 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10785 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10786 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10787 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10788 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10789 shift data through vir can be configured.
10790 @end itemize
10791 @end deffn
10792
10793 Examples:
10794 @example
10795 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10796 @end example
10797 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10798 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10799
10800 @example
10801 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10802 @end example
10803 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10804 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10805
10806 @node Utility Commands
10807 @chapter Utility Commands
10808 @cindex Utility Commands
10809
10810 @section RAM testing
10811 @cindex RAM testing
10812
10813 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10814 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10815 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10816 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10817 hardware problems.
10818
10819 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10820 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10821 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10822 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10823
10824 Load the memory testing functions with
10825
10826 @example
10827 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10828 @end example
10829
10830 to get access to the following facilities:
10831
10832 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10833 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10834 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10835 @end deffn
10836
10837 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10838 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10839 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10840 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10841 @end deffn
10842
10843 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10844 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10845 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10846 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10847 @end deffn
10848
10849 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10850 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10851 @end deffn
10852
10853 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10854 @cindex Firmware recovery
10855
10856 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10857 devices recovery with JTAG.
10858
10859 For quickstart instructions run:
10860 @example
10861 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10862 @end example
10863
10864 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10865 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10866 @cindex GDB
10867 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10868 to debug remote targets.
10869 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10870
10871 @itemize
10872 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10873 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10874 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10875 as shown in this chapter.
10876 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10877 that also will probably need to be configured.
10878 @end itemize
10879
10880 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10881 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10882 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10883 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10884 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10885 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10886
10887 @section Connecting to GDB
10888 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10889 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10890 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10891 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10892 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10893
10894 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10895
10896 @enumerate
10897 @item
10898 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10899 @example
10900 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10901 @end example
10902 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10903
10904 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10905 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10906 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10907
10908 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10909 remote command above that becomes:
10910 @example
10911 tar ext :3333
10912 @end example
10913
10914 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10915 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10916 available through the command:
10917 @example
10918 target remote localhost:3333
10919 @end example
10920
10921 @item
10922 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10923 @example
10924 target extended-remote | \
10925 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10926 @end example
10927 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10928 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10929 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10930 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10931 @end enumerate
10932
10933 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10934 GDB command line.
10935
10936 @section Sample GDB session startup
10937
10938 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10939 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10940 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10941 small ARM program.
10942 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10943 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10944
10945 @example
10946 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10947 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10948 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10949 ...
10950 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10951 ...
10952 (gdb) load
10953 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10954 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10955 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10956 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10957 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10958 (gdb) continue
10959 Continuing.
10960 ...
10961 @end example
10962
10963 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10964 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10965 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10966 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10967
10968 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10969
10970 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10971 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10972 packet size and the device's memory map.
10973 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10974 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10975 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10976
10977 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10978 You may need to set those up by hand.
10979 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10980 something like:
10981
10982 @example
10983 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10984 @end example
10985
10986 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10987
10988 @example
10989 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10990 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10991 @end example
10992
10993 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10994 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10995 do not have such restrictions.
10996
10997 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10998 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10999 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11000 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11001
11002 @section Programming using GDB
11003 @cindex Programming using GDB
11004 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11005
11006 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11007 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11008 @example
11009 gdb_memory_map disable
11010 @end example
11011 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11012 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11013 working area.
11014
11015 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11016 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11017 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11018 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11019
11020 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11021 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11022
11023 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11024 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11025 @example
11026 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11027 @end example
11028
11029 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11030 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11031
11032 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11033 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11034 will be used.
11035
11036 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11037 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11038 @example
11039 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11040 @end example
11041 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11042
11043 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11044 can be used.
11045
11046 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11047 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11048 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11049
11050 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11051 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11052 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11053
11054 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11055 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11056 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11057 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11058 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11059 without any intrusion of the target process.
11060
11061 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11062 Place following command after target configuration:
11063 @example
11064 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11065 @end example
11066
11067 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11068 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11069 @example
11070 gdb_memory_map disable
11071 @end example
11072
11073 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11074 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11075 @example
11076 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11077 @end example
11078
11079 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11080 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11081
11082 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11083 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11084 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11085 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11086
11087 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11088 previously shown variables.
11089
11090 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11091 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11092 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11093 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11094 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11095
11096 @section RTOS Support
11097 @cindex RTOS Support
11098 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11099
11100 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11101 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11102
11103 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11104 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11105 GDB commands.
11106
11107 @* An example setup is below:
11108
11109 @example
11110 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11111 @end example
11112
11113 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11114
11115 Currently supported rtos's include:
11116 @itemize @bullet
11117 @item @option{eCos}
11118 @item @option{ThreadX}
11119 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11120 @item @option{linux}
11121 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11122 @item @option{embKernel}
11123 @item @option{mqx}
11124 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11125 @item @option{nuttx}
11126 @item @option{RIOT}
11127 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11128 @item @option{Zephyr}
11129 @end itemize
11130
11131 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11132 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11133
11134 @table @code
11135 @item eCos symbols
11136 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11137 @item ThreadX symbols
11138 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11139 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11140 @raggedright
11141 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11142 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11143 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11144 @end raggedright
11145 @item linux symbols
11146 init_task.
11147 @item ChibiOS symbols
11148 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11149 @item embKernel symbols
11150 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11151 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11152 @item mqx symbols
11153 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11154 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11155 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11156 @item nuttx symbols
11157 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11158 @item RIOT symbols
11159 @raggedright
11160 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11161 _tcb_name_offset.
11162 @end raggedright
11163 @item Zephyr symbols
11164 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11165 @end table
11166
11167 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11168 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11169
11170 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11171 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11172
11173 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11174 along with the project:
11175
11176 @table @code
11177 @item FreeRTOS
11178 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11179 @item uC/OS-III
11180 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11181 @end table
11182
11183 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11184 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11185 @cindex SMP
11186 @cindex RTOS
11187 @cindex hwthread
11188 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11189 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11190 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11191 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11192 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11193 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11194 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11195 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11196 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11197
11198 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11199 @quotation Note
11200 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11201 @end quotation
11202
11203 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11204 @itemize @bullet
11205 @item j - smp status request
11206 @item J - smp set request
11207 @end itemize
11208
11209 OpenOCD implements :
11210 @itemize @bullet
11211 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11212 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11213 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11214 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11215 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11216 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11217 @end itemize
11218
11219 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11220 @itemize @bullet
11221 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11222 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11223 @example
11224 set $_core 1
11225 #Jc01 packet is sent
11226 print $_core
11227 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11228 @end example
11229
11230 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11231 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11232
11233 @example
11234 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11235 define toggle0
11236 maint packet Jc0
11237 continue
11238 main packet Jc-1
11239 end
11240 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11241 define toggle1
11242 maint packet Jc1
11243 continue
11244 main packet Jc-1
11245 end
11246 @end example
11247 @end itemize
11248
11249 @node Tcl Scripting API
11250 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11251 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11252 @cindex Tcl scripts
11253 @section API rules
11254
11255 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11256 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11257 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11258
11259 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11260 pair list and lists.
11261
11262 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11263 list.
11264
11265 @example
11266 > set foo(me) Duane
11267 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11268 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11269 > set foo(duck) Donald
11270 @end example
11271
11272 If one does this:
11273
11274 @example
11275 > set foo
11276 @end example
11277
11278 The result is:
11279
11280 @example
11281 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11282 @end example
11283
11284 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11285
11286 @verbatim
11287 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11288 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11289 }
11290 @end verbatim
11291
11292 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11293 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11294
11295 @section Internal low-level Commands
11296
11297 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11298 invoke directly.
11299
11300 @itemize @bullet
11301 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11302
11303 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11304 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11305
11306 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11307 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11308
11309 Return information about the flash banks
11310
11311 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11312
11313 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11314 its execution. Example:
11315
11316 @example
11317 > capture "reset init"
11318 @end example
11319
11320 @end itemize
11321
11322 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11323 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11324 called "flash_banks".
11325
11326 @section Tcl RPC server
11327 @cindex RPC
11328
11329 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11330 commands and receive the results.
11331
11332 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11333 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11334 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11335 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11336 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11337
11338 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11339 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11340 @command{capture} command.
11341
11342 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11343
11344 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11345 @cindex RPC Notifications
11346
11347 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11348 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11349
11350 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11351 in the following format.
11352
11353 @verbatim
11354 type target_event event [event-name]
11355 type target_state state [state-name]
11356 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11357 @end verbatim
11358
11359 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11360 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11361 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11362 Defaults to off.
11363
11364 @end deffn
11365
11366 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11367 @cindex RPC trace output
11368
11369 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11370 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11371
11372 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11373
11374 @verbatim
11375 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11376 @end verbatim
11377
11378 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11379 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11380 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11381 Defaults to off.
11382
11383 See an example application here:
11384 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11385
11386 @end deffn
11387
11388 @node FAQ
11389 @chapter FAQ
11390 @cindex faq
11391 @enumerate
11392 @anchor{faqrtck}
11393 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11394 @cindex RTCK
11395 @cindex adaptive clocking
11396 @*
11397
11398 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11399 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11400 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11401 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11402
11403 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11404 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11405 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11406 @enumerate
11407 @item
11408 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11409 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11410 @item
11411 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11412 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11413 @end enumerate
11414
11415 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11416 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11417 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11418 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11419 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11420 power).
11421
11422 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11423 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11424 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11425 ARM926 scenario).
11426 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11427 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11428 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11429
11430 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11431 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11432 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11433 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11434
11435 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11436
11437 In order to make use of this,
11438 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11439 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11440
11441 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11442 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11443 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11444 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11445 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11446
11447 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11448 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11449 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11450 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11451
11452 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11453 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11454 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11455 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11456 with a CPLD.
11457 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11458 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11459 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11460 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11461 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11462 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11463
11464 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11465
11466 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11467
11468 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11469 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11470 depending on the chips on your board.
11471 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11472 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11473 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11474
11475 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11476 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11477 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11478
11479 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11480 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11481 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11482 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11483
11484 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11485 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11486 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11487 this way.
11488
11489 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11490 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11491 clock rate.
11492 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11493 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11494 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11495
11496 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11497
11498 @example
11499 # Example: 1.234MHz
11500 adapter speed 1234
11501 @end example
11502
11503
11504 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11505
11506 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11507 around Windows filenames.
11508
11509 @example
11510 > echo \a
11511
11512 > echo @{\a@}
11513 \a
11514 > echo "\a"
11515
11516 >
11517 @end example
11518
11519
11520 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11521
11522 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11523 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11524 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11525
11526 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11527 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11528 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11529
11530 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11531 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11532 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11533
11534 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11535
11536 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11537 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11538 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11539 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11540
11541 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11542 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11543 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11544
11545 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11546 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11547
11548 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11549 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11550 memory read caused data abort".
11551
11552 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11553 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11554 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11555 be done, feel free to add this here.
11556
11557 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11558 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11559 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11560 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11561 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11562 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11563 gracefully stops.
11564
11565 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11566 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11567 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11568
11569 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11570 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11571 bytes. Painful...
11572
11573
11574 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11575 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11576
11577 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11578 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11579 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11580 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11581 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11582 reset, everything else should work fine.
11583
11584 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11585 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11586 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11587 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11588
11589 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11590 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11591 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11592 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11593
11594 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11595
11596 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11597 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11598 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11599
11600 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11601 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11602
11603 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11604 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11605 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11606 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11607 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11608 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11609 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11610 clock frequency?
11611
11612 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11613 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11614 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11615 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11616 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11617
11618 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11619
11620 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11621 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11622 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11623 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11624 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11625 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11626 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11627
11628 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11629
11630 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11631 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11632 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11633 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11634
11635 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11636 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11637 particular order?
11638
11639 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11640 the same order used by the hardware.
11641
11642 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11643 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11644 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11645 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11646 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11647 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11648
11649 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11650 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11651 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11652 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11653
11654 @itemize @bullet
11655 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11656 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11657 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11658 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11659 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11660 @end itemize
11661
11662 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11663
11664 @itemize @bullet
11665 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11666 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11667 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11668 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11669 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11670 @end itemize
11671
11672
11673 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11674 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11675 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11676
11677 TODO.
11678
11679 @end enumerate
11680
11681 @node Tcl Crash Course
11682 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11683 @cindex Tcl
11684
11685 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11686 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11687 how the Tcl scripts work.
11688
11689 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11690 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11691 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11692 OpenOCD.
11693
11694 @section Tcl Rule #1
11695 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11696 @enumerate
11697 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11698 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11699 @end enumerate
11700
11701 The Tcl equal is this:
11702
11703 @enumerate
11704 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11705 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11706 @end enumerate
11707
11708 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11709 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11710
11711 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11712 There is a second pair of rules.
11713 @enumerate
11714 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11715 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11716 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11717 in Tcl.
11718 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11719 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11720 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11721 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11722 @end enumerate
11723
11724 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11725 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11726 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11727 Everything is a string}
11728
11729 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11730 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11731 difference is subtle.
11732 @enumerate
11733 @item Parse Time
11734 @item Evaluation Time
11735 @end enumerate
11736
11737 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11738 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11739 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11740
11741 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11742 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11743 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11744 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11745
11746 @itemize @bullet
11747 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11748 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11749 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11750 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11751 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11752 @example
11753 # bash example
11754 X=`date`
11755 echo "The Date is: $X"
11756 # Tcl example
11757 set X [date]
11758 puts "The Date is: $X"
11759 @end example
11760 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11761 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11762 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11763 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11764 is a string}
11765 @example
11766 set x "Dinner"
11767 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11768 @end example
11769 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11770 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11771 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11772 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11773 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11774 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11775 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11776 @end itemize
11777
11778 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11779
11780 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11781
11782 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11783
11784 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11785 the normal way.
11786
11787 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11788 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11789 line is immediately executed.
11790
11791 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11792 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11793
11794 @subsection Command Execution
11795
11796 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11797 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11798 control flow operators.
11799
11800 Commands are executed like this:
11801
11802 @enumerate
11803 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11804 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11805 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11806 @end enumerate
11807
11808 It sort of works like this:
11809 @example
11810 for(;;)@{
11811 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11812
11813 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11814
11815 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11816 @}
11817 @end example
11818
11819 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11820 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11821 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11822 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11823 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11824 ``LookupCommand()''
11825
11826 @subsection The FOR command
11827
11828 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11829 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11830 command just like any other command.
11831
11832 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11833 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11834 are:
11835
11836 @enumerate 0
11837 @item The ascii text 'for'
11838 @item The start text
11839 @item The test expression
11840 @item The next text
11841 @item The body text
11842 @end enumerate
11843
11844 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11845 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11846 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11847 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11848
11849 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11850 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11851
11852 @example
11853 int
11854 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11855 int *argc,
11856 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11857 @end example
11858
11859 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11860 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11861 still operates in the same basic way.
11862
11863 @subsection FOR command implementation
11864
11865 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11866 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11867
11868 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11869
11870 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11871
11872 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11873 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11874 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11875
11876 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11877 expression and returns a value.
11878
11879 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11880 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11881 @example
11882 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11883
11884 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11885
11886 int
11887 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11888 int argc,
11889 char **argv )
11890 @{
11891 if( argc != 5 )@{
11892 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11893 return ERROR;
11894 @}
11895
11896 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11897
11898 // Execute the start statement.
11899 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11900
11901 // Top of loop test
11902 for(;;)@{
11903 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11904 if( i == 0 )
11905 break;
11906
11907 // Execute the body
11908 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11909
11910 // Execute the LOOP part
11911 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11912 @}
11913
11914 // Return no error
11915 SetResult( interp, "" );
11916 return SUCCESS;
11917 @}
11918 @end example
11919
11920 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11921 in the same basic way.
11922
11923 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11924
11925 @subsection source and find commands
11926 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11927 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11928 @*Remember the parsing rules
11929 @enumerate
11930 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11931 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11932 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11933 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11934 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11935 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11936 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11937 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11938 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11939 @end enumerate
11940 @subsection format command
11941 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11942 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11943 @b{sprintf()}.
11944 @b{Example}
11945 @example
11946 set x 6
11947 set y 7
11948 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11949 @end example
11950 @enumerate
11951 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11952 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11953 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11954 @* Refer to Rule #1
11955 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11956 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11957 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11958 @end enumerate
11959 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11960 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11961 @example
11962 #1 Good
11963 proc someproc @{@} @{
11964 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11965 @}
11966 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11967 #2 Good - no variables
11968 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11969 #3 Good Curly Braces
11970 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11971 puts "Time: [date]"
11972 @}
11973 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11974 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11975 @end example
11976 @enumerate
11977 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11978 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11979 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11980 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11981 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11982 command.
11983 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11984 @*There are 4 examples:
11985 @enumerate
11986 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11987 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11988 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11989 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11990 @end enumerate
11991
11992 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11993 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11994 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11995
11996 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11997 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11998 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11999 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12000 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12001 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12002 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12003 @end enumerate
12004 @subsection Global Variables
12005 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12006 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12007 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12008 @example
12009 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12010 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12011 global x #Global variable X
12012 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12013 @}
12014 @end example
12015 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12016 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12017 @example
12018 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12019 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12020 # Create var name
12021 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12022 # Make it a global
12023 global $vn
12024 # Set it.
12025 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12026 @}
12027 @end example
12028 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12029 @example
12030 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12031 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12032 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12033 @}
12034 @end example
12035
12036 @node License
12037 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12038 @include fdl.texi
12039
12040 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12041 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12042 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12043 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12044 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12045 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12046
12047 @printindex cp
12048
12049 @node Command and Driver Index
12050 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12051 @printindex fn
12052
12053 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)